US20130274261A1 - Methods for treating pulmonary hypertension - Google Patents

Methods for treating pulmonary hypertension Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20130274261A1
US20130274261A1 US13/845,533 US201313845533A US2013274261A1 US 20130274261 A1 US20130274261 A1 US 20130274261A1 US 201313845533 A US201313845533 A US 201313845533A US 2013274261 A1 US2013274261 A1 US 2013274261A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
amino
phenyl
mmol
propanoic acid
pyrimidin
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US13/845,533
Inventor
Arthur T. Sands
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Individual
Original Assignee
Individual
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Individual filed Critical Individual
Priority to US13/845,533 priority Critical patent/US20130274261A1/en
Publication of US20130274261A1 publication Critical patent/US20130274261A1/en
Assigned to BIOPHARMA CREDIT PLC reassignment BIOPHARMA CREDIT PLC SECURITY INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: LEXICON PHARMACEUTICALS, INC.
Assigned to LEXICON PHARMACEUTICALS, INC. reassignment LEXICON PHARMACEUTICALS, INC. RELEASE BY SECURED PARTY (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: BIOPHARMA CREDIT PLC
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K45/00Medicinal preparations containing active ingredients not provided for in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • A61K45/06Mixtures of active ingredients without chemical characterisation, e.g. antiphlogistics and cardiaca
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/185Acids; Anhydrides, halides or salts thereof, e.g. sulfur acids, imidic, hydrazonic or hydroximic acids
    • A61K31/19Carboxylic acids, e.g. valproic acid
    • A61K31/195Carboxylic acids, e.g. valproic acid having an amino group
    • A61K31/197Carboxylic acids, e.g. valproic acid having an amino group the amino and the carboxyl groups being attached to the same acyclic carbon chain, e.g. gamma-aminobutyric acid [GABA], beta-alanine, epsilon-aminocaproic acid or pantothenic acid
    • A61K31/198Alpha-amino acids, e.g. alanine or edetic acid [EDTA]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/40Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. sulpiride, succinimide, tolmetin, buflomedil
    • A61K31/403Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. sulpiride, succinimide, tolmetin, buflomedil condensed with carbocyclic rings, e.g. carbazole
    • A61K31/404Indoles, e.g. pindolol
    • A61K31/405Indole-alkanecarboxylic acids; Derivatives thereof, e.g. tryptophan, indomethacin
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/41Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with two or more ring hetero atoms, at least one of which being nitrogen, e.g. tetrazole
    • A61K31/41921,2,3-Triazoles
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/44Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/4418Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof having a carbocyclic group directly attached to the heterocyclic ring, e.g. cyproheptadine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4965Non-condensed pyrazines
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4965Non-condensed pyrazines
    • A61K31/497Non-condensed pyrazines containing further heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/505Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/53Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with three nitrogens as the only ring hetero atoms, e.g. chlorazanil, melamine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/535Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with at least one nitrogen and one oxygen as the ring hetero atoms, e.g. 1,2-oxazines
    • A61K31/53751,4-Oxazines, e.g. morpholine
    • A61K31/53771,4-Oxazines, e.g. morpholine not condensed and containing further heterocyclic rings, e.g. timolol
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/557Eicosanoids, e.g. leukotrienes or prostaglandins
    • A61K31/5578Eicosanoids, e.g. leukotrienes or prostaglandins having a pentalene ring system, e.g. carbacyclin, iloprost
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/557Eicosanoids, e.g. leukotrienes or prostaglandins
    • A61K31/558Eicosanoids, e.g. leukotrienes or prostaglandins having heterocyclic rings containing oxygen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. thromboxanes
    • A61K31/5585Eicosanoids, e.g. leukotrienes or prostaglandins having heterocyclic rings containing oxygen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. thromboxanes having five-membered rings containing oxygen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. prostacyclin
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/12Antihypertensives

Definitions

  • This invention relates to methods and compositions for the treatment of pulmonary hypertension and related diseases and disorders.
  • Pulmonary hypertension or pulmonary arterial hypertension (PAH) is a disease characterized by increased pulmonary artery pressure and pulmonary vascular resistance.
  • WHO Group 1.1 is idiopathic pulmonary arterial hypertension (IPAH). This refers to PAH that occurs at random, without an apparent cause. IPAH used to be called “primary pulmonary hypertension” or PPH. Id.
  • the second type, WHO Group 1.2, is familial pulmonary arterial hypertension (FPAH).
  • FPAH familial pulmonary arterial hypertension
  • the third type, WHO Group 1.3 is pulmonary arterial hypertension associated with other diseases or conditions (APAH). This used to be called “PAH secondary to other conditions” or Secondary PAH.
  • This category includes PAH associated with collagen vascular disease or “connective tissue disease” (e.g., scleroderma (SSc)-including CREST syndrome-lupus (SLE)), congenital systemic-to-pulmonary shunts (congenital heart disease), portal hypertension, HIV infection, drugs and toxins, and other diseases and disorders (e.g., thyroid disorders, glycogen storage diseases, Gaucher disease, hereditary hemorrhagic telangiectasia, hemoglobinopathies, myeloproliferative disorders, splenectomy). Id.
  • the fourth type, WHO Group 1.4 is pulmonary arterial hypertension associated with significant venous or capillary involvement, and includes pulmonary veno-occlusive disease (PVOD) and pulmonary capillary hemangiomatosis (PCH).
  • PVOD pulmonary veno-occlusive disease
  • PCH pulmonary capillary hemangiomatosis
  • the fifth and final type, WHO Group 1.5, is persistent pulmonary hypertension of the newborn. Id.
  • Drugs currently used to treat PH include pulmonary vasodilators, calcium channel blockers, and inhibitors of platelet aggregation.
  • Diuretics, nitric oxide, phosphodiesterase 5 inhibitors (e.g., sildenafil) and endothelin receptor antagonists (ERAs) are also used for its treatment. Ulrich, S., et al., Swiss Med. Wkly 137:73-82, 76-77 (2007).
  • Endothelin receptor antagonists work by binding to the ET A and/or ET B receptor sites in the endothelium and vasculature smooth muscle, thereby preventing the neurohormone endothelin-1 (ET-1) from binding to these same receptor sites and triggering vasoconstriction. Id. at 76-77.
  • An example of an ERA is bosentan (TRACLEER®).
  • SSRIs selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors
  • 5-HT neurotransmitter serotonin
  • Serotonin is synthesized in two steps from the amino acid tryptophan. Goodman & Gilman's The Pharmacological Basis of Therapeutics, 10 th ed., p. 270 (McGraw-Hill, 2001). The first step is rate-limiting, and is catalyzed by the enzyme tryptophan hydroxylase (TPH), which has two known isoforms: TPH1, which is expressed in the periphery, and TPH2, which is expressed primarily in the brain. Walther, D. J., et al., Science 299:76 (2003). Mice genetically deficient for the tph1 gene (“knockout mice”) have been reported.
  • TPH tryptophan hydroxylase
  • mice reportedly expressed normal amounts of serotonin in classical serotonergic brain regions, but largely lacked serotonin in the periphery. Id. In another, the knockout mice exhibited abnormal cardiac activity, which was attributed to a lack of peripheral serotonin. Côté, F., et al., PNAS 100(23):13525-13530 (2003). Recently, TPH knockout mice were studied in a hypoxia-induced pulmonary arterial hypertension model. Morecroft, I., et al., Hypertension 49:232-236 (2007). The results of those studies suggest that TPH1 and peripheral serotonin “play an essential role in the development of hypoxia-induced elevations in pulmonary pressures and hypoxia-induced pulmonary vascular remodeling.” Id. at 232.
  • This invention is directed, in part, to methods of treating pulmonary hypertension and related diseases and disorders, which comprise administering to a patient therapeutically effective amounts of a tryptophan hydroxylase (TPH) inhibitor and at least one other active pharmaceutical ingredient.
  • TPH tryptophan hydroxylase
  • One embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of an endothelin receptor antagonist and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of nitric oxide or a nitric oxide precursor or releasing compound, and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • the invention also encompasses pharmaceutical formulations (e.g., single unit dosage forms) comprising a TPH inhibitor and at least one other active pharmaceutical ingredient.
  • pharmaceutical formulations e.g., single unit dosage forms
  • This invention is based, in part, on studies of tph1 knockout mice and the discovery of compounds that inhibit tryptophan hydroxylase (e.g., TPH1).
  • alkenyl means a straight chain, branched and/or cyclic hydrocarbon having from 2 to 20 (e.g., 2 to 10 or 2 to 6) carbon atoms, and including at least one carbon-carbon double bond.
  • alkyl means a straight chain, branched and/or cyclic (“cycloalkyl”) hydrocarbon having from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1 to 10 or 1 to 4) carbon atoms. Alkyl moieties having from 1 to 4 carbons are referred to as “lower alkyl.” Examples of alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, hexyl, isohexyl, heptyl, 4,4-dimethylpentyl, octyl, 2,2,4-trimethylpentyl, nonyl, decyl, undecyl and dodecyl.
  • Cycloalkyl moieties may be monocyclic or multicyclic, and examples include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, and adamantyl. Additional examples of alkyl moieties have linear, branched and/or cyclic portions (e.g., 1-ethyl-4-methyl-cyclohexyl).
  • alkyl includes saturated hydrocarbons as well as alkenyl and alkynyl moieties.
  • alkoxy means an —O-alkyl group. Examples of alkoxy groups include —OCH 3 , —OCH 2 CH 3 , —O(CH 2 ) 2 CH 3 , —O(CH 2 ) 3 CH 3 , —O(CH 2 ) 4 CH 3 , and —O(CH 2 ) 5 CH 3 .
  • alkylaryl or “alkyl-aryl” means an alkyl moiety bound to an aryl moiety.
  • alkylheteroaryl or “alkyl-heteroaryl” means an alkyl moiety bound to a heteroaryl moiety.
  • alkylheterocycle or “alkyl-heterocycle” means an alkyl moiety bound to a heterocycle moiety.
  • alkynyl means a straight chain, branched or cyclic hydrocarbon having from 2 to 20 (e.g., 2 to 20 or 2 to 6) carbon atoms, and including at least one carbon-carbon triple bond.
  • alkynyl moieties include acetylenyl, propynyl, 1-butynyl, 2-butynyl, 1-pentynyl, 2-pentynyl, 3-methyl-1-butynyl, 4-pentynyl, 1-hexynyl, 2-hexynyl, 5-hexynyl, 1-heptynyl, 2-heptynyl, 6-heptynyl, 1-octynyl, 2-octynyl, 7-octynyl, 1-nonynyl, 2-nonynyl, 8-nonynyl, 1-decynyl, 2-decynyl and 9-decynyl.
  • aryl means an aromatic ring or an aromatic or partially aromatic ring system composed of carbon and hydrogen atoms.
  • An aryl moiety may comprise multiple rings bound or fused together.
  • aryl moieties include anthracenyl, azulenyl, biphenyl, fluorenyl, indan, indenyl, naphthyl, phenanthrenyl, phenyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-naphthalene, and tolyl.
  • arylalkyl or “aryl-alkyl” means an aryl moiety bound to an alkyl moiety.
  • biohydrolyzable amide means an amide, ester, carbamate, carbonate, ureido, or phosphate, respectively, of a compound that either: 1) does not interfere with the biological activity of the compound but can confer upon that compound advantageous properties in vivo, such as uptake, duration of action, or onset of action; or 2) is biologically inactive but is converted in vivo to the biologically active compound.
  • biohydrolyzable esters include lower alkyl esters, alkoxyacyloxy esters, alkyl acylamino alkyl esters, and choline esters.
  • biohydrolyzable amides include lower alkyl amides, ⁇ -amino acid amides, alkoxyacyl amides, and alkylaminoalkyl-carbonyl amides.
  • biohydrolyzable carbamates include lower alkylamines, substituted ethylenediamines, aminoacids, hydroxyalkylamines, heterocyclic and heteroaromatic amines, and polyether amines.
  • halogen and “halo” encompass fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
  • heteroalkyl refers to an alkyl moiety (e.g., linear, branched or cyclic) in which at least one of its carbon atoms has been replaced with a heteroatom (e.g., N, O or S).
  • heteroaryl means an aryl moiety wherein at least one of its carbon atoms has been replaced with a heteroatom (e.g., N, O or S).
  • heteroatom e.g., N, O or S.
  • examples include acridinyl, benzimidazolyl, benzofuranyl, benzoisothiazolyl, benzoisoxazolyl, benzoquinazolinyl, benzothiazolyl, benzoxazolyl, furyl, imidazolyl, indolyl, isothiazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, oxazolyl, phthalazinyl, pyrazinyl, pyrazolyl, pyridazinyl, pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrimidyl, pyrrolyl, quinazolinyl, quinolinyl, tetrazolyl, thiazolyl, and tri
  • heteroarylalkyl or “heteroaryl-alkyl” means a heteroaryl moiety bound to an alkyl moiety.
  • heterocycle refers to an aromatic, partially aromatic or non-aromatic monocyclic or polycyclic ring or ring system comprised of carbon, hydrogen and at least one heteroatom (e.g., N, O or S).
  • a heterocycle may comprise multiple (i.e., two or more) rings fused or bound together.
  • Heterocycles include heteroaryls.
  • Examples include benzo[1,3]dioxolyl, 2,3-dihydro-benzo[1,4]dioxinyl, cinnolinyl, furanyl, hydantoinyl, morpholinyl, oxetanyl, oxiranyl, piperazinyl, piperidinyl, pyrrolidinonyl, pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydropyridinyl, tetrahydropyrimidinyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl and valerolactamyl.
  • heterocyclealkyl or “heterocycle-alkyl” refers to a heterocycle moiety bound to an alkyl moiety.
  • heterocycloalkyl refers to a non-aromatic heterocycle.
  • heterocycloalkylalkyl or “heterocycloalkyl-alkyl” refers to a heterocycloalkyl moiety bound to an alkyl moiety.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable salts refers to salts prepared from pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic acids or bases including inorganic acids and bases and organic acids and bases.
  • suitable pharmaceutically acceptable base addition salts include metallic salts made from aluminum, calcium, lithium, magnesium, potassium, sodium and zinc or organic salts made from lysine, N,N′-dibenzylethylenediamine, chloroprocaine, choline, diethanolamine, ethylenediamine, meglumine (N-methylglucamine) and procaine.
  • Suitable non-toxic acids include inorganic and organic acids such as acetic, alginic, anthranilic, benzenesulfonic, benzoic, camphorsulfonic, citric, ethenesulfonic, formic, fumaric, furoic, galacturonic, gluconic, glucuronic, glutamic, glycolic, hydrobromic, hydrochloric, isethionic, lactic, maleic, malic, mandelic, methanesulfonic, mucic, nitric, pamoic, pantothenic, phenylacetic, phosphoric, propionic, salicylic, stearic, succinic, sulfanilic, sulfuric, tartaric acid, and p-toluenesulfonic acid.
  • inorganic and organic acids such as acetic, alginic, anthranilic, benzenesulfonic, benzoic, camphorsulfonic, citric, ethe
  • Non-toxic acids include hydrochloric, hydrobromic, phosphoric, sulfuric, and methanesulfonic acids.
  • Examples of specific salts thus include hydrochloride and mesylate salts.
  • Others are well-known in the art. See, e.g., Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18 th ed. (Mack Publishing, Easton Pa.: 1990) and Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, 19 th ed. (Mack Publishing, Easton Pa.: 1995).
  • potent TPH1 inhibitor is a compound that has a TPH1_IC 50 of less than about 10 ⁇ M.
  • prodrug encompasses pharmaceutically acceptable esters, carbonates, thiocarbonates, N-acyl derivatives, N-acyloxyalkyl derivatives, quaternary derivatives of tertiary amines, N-Mannich bases, Schiff bases, amino acid conjugates, phosphate esters, metal salts and sulfonate esters of compounds disclosed herein.
  • prodrugs include compounds that comprise a biohydrolyzable moiety (e.g., a biohydrolyzable amide, biohydrolyzable carbamate, biohydrolyzable carbonate, biohydrolyzable ester, biohydrolyzable phosphate, or biohydrolyzable ureide analog).
  • Prodrugs of compounds disclosed herein are readily envisioned and prepared by those of ordinary skill in the art. See, e.g., Design of Prodrugs, Bundgaard, A. Ed., Elseview, 1985; Bundgaard, H., “ Design and Application of Prodrugs,” A Textbook of Drug Design and Development , Krosgaard-Larsen and H. Bundgaard, Ed., 1991, Chapter 5, p. 113-191; and Bundgaard, H., Advanced Drug Delivery Review, 1992, 8, 1-38.
  • a “prophylactically effective amount” of a compound is an amount sufficient to prevent a disease or condition, or one or more symptoms associated with the disease or condition, or prevent its recurrence.
  • a prophylactically effective amount of a compound is an amount of therapeutic agent, alone or in combination with other agents, which provides a prophylactic benefit in the prevention of the disease.
  • the term “prophylactically effective amount” can encompass an amount that improves overall prophylaxis or enhances the prophylactic efficacy of another prophylactic agent.
  • protecting group when used to refer to part of a molecule subjected to a chemical reaction, means a chemical moiety that is not reactive under the conditions of that chemical reaction, and which may be removed to provide a moiety that is reactive under those conditions.
  • Protecting groups are well known in the art. See, e.g., Greene, T. W. and Wuts, P.G.M., Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis (3 rd ed., John Wiley & Sons: 1999); Larock, R. C., Comprehensive Organic Transformations (2 nd ed., John Wiley & Sons: 1999). Some examples include benzyl, diphenylmethyl, trityl, Cbz, Boc, Fmoc, methoxycarbonyl, ethoxycarbonyl, and pthalimido.
  • pseudohalogen refers to a polyatomic anion that resembles a halide ion in its acid-base, substitution, and redox chemistry, generally has low basicity, and forms a free radical under atom transfer radical polymerization conditions.
  • pseudohalogens include azide ions, cyanide, cyanate, thiocyanate, thiosulfate, sulfonates, and sulfonyl halides.
  • selective TPH1 inhibitor is a compound that has a TPH2_IC 50 that is at least about 10 times greater than its TPH1_IC 50 .
  • statin-mediated adverse effect refers to an adverse effect that is attributable to increased levels of peripheral 5-hydroxytryptamine (5-HT).
  • stereomerically enriched composition of a compound refers to a mixture of the named compound and its stereoisomer(s) that contains more of the named compound than its stereoisomer(s).
  • a stereoisomerically enriched composition of (5)-butan-2-ol encompasses mixtures of (S)-butan-2-ol and (R)-butan-2-ol in ratios of, e.g., about 60/40, 70/30, 80/20, 90/10, 95/5, and 98/2.
  • stereomerically pure means a composition that comprises one stereoisomer of a compound and is substantially free of other stereoisomers of that compound.
  • a stereomerically pure composition of a compound having one stereocenter will be substantially free of the opposite stereoisomer of the compound.
  • a stereomerically pure composition of a compound having two stereocenters will be substantially free of other diastereomers of the compound.
  • substituted when used to describe a chemical structure or moiety, refers to a derivative of that structure or moiety wherein one or more of its hydrogen atoms is substituted with an atom, chemical moiety or functional group such as, but not limited to, alcohol, aldehylde, alkoxy, alkanoyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkenyl, alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, propyl, t-butyl), alkynyl, alkylcarbonyloxy (—OC(O)alkyl), amide (—C(O)NH-alkyl- or -alkylNHC(O)alkyl), amidinyl (—C(NH)NH-alkyl or —C(NR)NH 2 ), amine (primary, secondary and tertiary such as alkylamino, arylamino, arylalkylamino), aroyl, aryl,
  • a “therapeutically effective amount” of a compound is an amount sufficient to provide a therapeutic benefit in the treatment or management of a disease or condition, or to delay or minimize one or more symptoms associated with the disease or condition.
  • a therapeutically effective amount of a compound is an amount of therapeutic agent, alone or in combination with other therapies, which provides a therapeutic benefit in the treatment or management of the disease or condition.
  • the term “therapeutically effective amount” can encompass an amount that improves overall therapy, reduces or avoids symptoms or causes of a disease or condition, or enhances the therapeutic efficacy of another therapeutic agent.
  • TPH1_IC 50 is the IC 50 of a compound for TPH1 as determined using the in vitro inhibition assay described in the Examples, below.
  • TPH2_IC 50 is the IC 50 of a compound for TPH2 as determined using the in vitro inhibition assay described in the Examples, below.
  • the terms “treat,” “treating” and “treatment” contemplate an action that occurs while a patient is suffering from the specified disease or disorder, which reduces the severity of the disease or disorder, or one or more of its symptoms, or retards or slows the progression of the disease or disorder.
  • the term “include” has the same meaning as “include” and the term “includes” has the same meaning as “includes, but is not limited to.” Similarly, the term “such as” has the same meaning as the term “such as, but not limited to.”
  • one or more adjectives immediately preceding a series of nouns is to be construed as applying to each of the nouns.
  • the phrase “optionally substituted alky, aryl, or heteroaryl” has the same meaning as “optionally substituted alky, optionally substituted aryl, or optionally substituted heteroaryl.”
  • a chemical moiety that forms part of a larger compound may be described herein using a name commonly accorded it when it exists as a single molecule or a name commonly accorded its radical.
  • the terms “pyridine” and “pyridyl” are accorded the same meaning when used to describe a moiety attached to other chemical moieties.
  • the two phrases “XOH, wherein X is pyridyl” and “XOH, wherein X is pyridine” are accorded the same meaning, and encompass the compounds pyridin-2-ol, pyridin-3-ol and pyridin-4-ol.
  • stereochemistry of a structure or a portion of a structure is not indicated with, for example, bold or dashed lines, the structure or the portion of the structure is to be interpreted as encompassing all stereoisomers of it.
  • names of compounds having one or more chiral centers that do not specify the stereochemistry of those centers encompass pure stereoisomers and mixtures thereof.
  • any atom shown in a drawing with unsatisfied valences is assumed to be attached to enough hydrogen atoms to satisfy the valences.
  • chemical bonds depicted with one solid line parallel to one dashed line encompass both single and double (e.g., aromatic) bonds, if valences permit.
  • Particular embodiments of this invention utilize compounds capable of inhibiting tryptophan hydroxylase (TPH).
  • Preferred compounds are potent TPH1 inhibitors. Examples of potent TPH1 inhibitors are disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/638,677, filed Dec. 12, 2006.
  • A is optionally substituted cycloalkyl, aryl, or heterocycle
  • X is a bond, —O—, —S—, —C(O)—, —C(R 4 ) ⁇ , ⁇ C(R 4 )—, —C(R 3 R 4 )—, —C(R 4 ) ⁇ C(R 4 )—, —C ⁇ C—, —N(R 5 )—, —N(R 5 )C(O)N(R 5 )—, —C(R 3 R 4 )N(R 5 )—, —N(R 5 )C(R 3 R 4 )—, —ONC(R 3 )—, —C(R 3 )NO—, —C(R 3 R 4 )O—, —OC(R 3 R 4 )—, —S(O 2 )—, —S(O 2 )N(R 5 )——
  • A is optionally substituted cycloalkyl, aryl, or heterocycle
  • X is a bond, —O—, —S—, —C(O)—, —C(R 4 ) ⁇ , ⁇ C(R 4 )—, —C(R 3 R 4 )—, —C(R 4 ) ⁇ C(R 4 )—, —C ⁇ C—, —N(R 5 )—, —N(R 5 )C(O)N(R 5 )—, —C(R 3 R 4 )N(R 5 )—, —N(R 5 )C(R 3 R 4 )—, —ONC(R 3 )—, —C(R 3 )NO—, —C(R 3 R 4 )O—, —OC(R 3 R 4 )—, —S(O 2 )—, —S(O 2 )N(R 5 )——
  • particular compounds include those wherein A is optionally substituted cycloalkyl (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered).
  • A is optionally substituted aryl (e.g., phenyl or naphthyl).
  • A is optionally substituted heterocycle (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered).
  • 6-membered heterocycles include pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine, pyrazine, and triazine.
  • 5-membered heterocycles include pyrrole, imidazole, triazole, thiazole, thiophene, and furan.
  • A is aromatic. In others, A is not aromatic. In some, A is an optionally substituted bicyclic moiety (e.g., indole, iso-indole, pyrrolo-pyridine, or napthylene).
  • each of A 1 and A 2 is independently a monocyclic optionally substituted cycloalkyl, aryl, or heterocycle.
  • Compounds encompassed by this formula include those wherein A 1 and/or A 2 is optionally substituted cycloalkyl (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered).
  • a 1 and/or A 2 is optionally substituted aryl (e.g., phenyl or naphthyl).
  • a 1 and/or A 2 is optionally substituted heterocycle (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered). Examples of 6-membered heterocycles include pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine, pyrazine, and triazine.
  • 5-membered heterocycles include pyrrole, imidazole, triazole, thiazole, thiophene, and furan.
  • a 1 and/or A 2 is aromatic. In others, A 1 and/or A 2 is not aromatic.
  • D is optionally substituted aryl (e.g., phenyl or naphthyl).
  • D is optionally substituted heterocycle (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered).
  • 6-membered heterocycles include pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine, pyrazine, and triazine.
  • 5-membered heterocycles include pyrrole, imidazole, triazole, thiazole, thiophene, and furan.
  • D is aromatic.
  • D is not aromatic.
  • D is an optionally substituted bicyclic moiety (e.g., indole, iso-indole, pyrrolo-pyridine, or napthylene).
  • E is optionally substituted aryl (e.g., phenyl or naphthyl).
  • E is optionally substituted heterocycle (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered).
  • 6-membered heterocycles include pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine, pyrazine, and triazine.
  • 5-membered heterocycles include pyrrole, imidazole, triazole, thiazole, thiophene, and furan.
  • E is aromatic.
  • E is not aromatic.
  • E is an optionally substituted bicyclic moiety (e.g., indole, iso-indole, pyrrolo-pyridine, or napthylene).
  • particular compounds include those wherein R 1 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl.
  • R 2 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl.
  • n 1 or 2.
  • X is a bond or S.
  • X is —C(R 4 ) ⁇ , ⁇ C(R 4 )—, —C(R 3 R 4 )—, —C(R 4 ) ⁇ C(R 4 )—, or —C ⁇ C—, and, for example, R 4 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl.
  • X is —O—, —C(R 3 R 4 )O—, or —OC(R 3 R 4 )—, and, for example, R 3 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, and R 4 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl.
  • R 3 is hydrogen and R 4 is trifluoromethyl.
  • X is —S(O 2 )—, —S(O 2 )N(R 5 )—, —N(R 5 )S(O 2 )—, —C(R 3 R 4 )S(O 2 )—, or —S(O 2 )C(R 3 R 4 )—, and, for example, R 3 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, R 4 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, and R 5 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl.
  • X is —N(R 5 )—, —N(R 5 )C(O)N(R 5 )—, —C(R 3 R 4 )N(R 5 )—, or —N(R 5 )C(R 3 R 4 )—, and, for example, R 3 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, R 4 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, and each R 5 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl.
  • R 3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are encompassed by the formula:
  • R 3 is hydrogen
  • each of Z 1 , Z 2 , Z 3 , and Z 4 is independently N or CR 6 ; each R 6 is independently hydrogen, cyano, halogen, OR 7 , NR 8 R 9 , amino, hydroxyl, or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 7 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 8 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 9 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; and m is 1-4. Certain such compounds are of the formula:
  • R 3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are of the formula:
  • R 3 is hydrogen
  • some compounds are such that all of Z 1 , Z 2 , Z 3 , and Z 4 are N. In others, only three of Z 1 , Z 2 , Z 3 , and Z 4 are N. In others, only two of Z 1 , Z 2 , Z 3 , and Z 4 are N. In others, only one of Z 1 , Z 2 , Z 3 , and Z 4 is N. In others, none of Z 1 , Z 2 , Z 3 , and Z 4 are N.
  • each of Z′ 1 , Z′ 2 , and Z′ 3 is independently N, NH, S, O or CR 6 ; each R 6 is independently amino, cyano, halogen, hydrogen, OR 7 , SR 7 , NR 8 R 9 , or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 7 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 8 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 9 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; and p is 1-3. Certain such compounds are of the formula:
  • R 3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are of the formula:
  • R 3 is hydrogen
  • some compounds are such that all of Z′ 1 , Z′ 2 , and Z′ 3 are N or NH. In others, only two of Z′ 1 , Z′ 2 , and Z′ 3 are N or NH. In others, only one of Z′ 1 , Z′ 2 , and Z′ 3 is N or NH. In others, none of Z′ 1 , Z′ 2 , and Z′ 3 are N or NH.
  • each of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 is independently N or CR 10 ; each R 10 is independently amino, cyano, halogen, hydrogen, OR 11 , SR 11 , NR 12 R 13 , or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 11 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 12 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; and each R 13 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle. Certain such compounds are of the formula:
  • R 3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are of the formula:
  • R 3 is hydrogen
  • some compounds are such that all of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 are N. In others, only three of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 are N. In others, only two of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 are N. In others, only one of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 is N. In others, none of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 are N.
  • each of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 is independently N or CR 10 ; each R 10 is independently amino, cyano, halogen, hydrogen, OR 11 , SR 11 , NR 12 R 13 , or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 11 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R 12 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; and each R 13 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle. Certain such compounds are of the formula:
  • R 3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are of the formula:
  • R 3 is hydrogen
  • some compounds are such that all of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 are N. In others, only three of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 are N. In others, only two of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 are N. In others, only one of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 is N. In others, none of Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 are N.
  • particular compounds include those wherein both A and E are optionally substituted phenyl and, for example, X is —O—, —C(R 3 R 4 )O—, or —OC(R 3 R 4 )— and, for example, R 3 is hydrogen and R 4 is trifluoromethyl and, for example, n is 1.
  • This invention encompasses stereomerically pure compounds and stereomerically enriched compositions of them. Stereoisomers may be asymmetrically synthesized or resolved using standard techniques such as chiral columns, chiral resolving agents, or enzymatic resolution.
  • Particular compounds of the invention are potent TPH1 inhibitors.
  • Specific compounds have a TPH1_IC 50 of less than about 10, 5, 2.5, 1, 0.75, 0.5, 0.4, 0.3, 0.2, 0.1, or 0.05 ⁇ M.
  • Particular compounds are selective TPH1 inhibitors.
  • Specific compounds have a TPH1_IC 50 that is about 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500, or 1000 times less than their TPH2_IC 50 .
  • Particular compounds do not significantly inhibit human tyrosine hydroxylase (TH).
  • specific compounds have an IC 50 for TH of greater than about 100, 250, 500 or 1000 ⁇ m.
  • Particular compounds do not significantly inhibit human phenylalanine hydroxylase (PAH).
  • PAH human phenylalanine hydroxylase
  • specific compounds have an IC 50 for PAH of greater than about 100, 250, 500 or 1000 ⁇ M.
  • Particular compounds of the invention do not significantly bind (e.g., inhibit with an IC 50 of greater than about 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500, 750, or 1000 ⁇ M) to one or more of the following: angiotensin converting enzyme, erythropoietin (EPO) receptor, factor IX, factor XI, integrin (e.g., ⁇ 4), isoxazoline or isoxazole fibrinogen receptor, metalloprotease, neutral endopeptidase (NEP), phosphatase (e.g., tyrosine phosphatase), phosphodiesterase (e.g., PDE-4), polymerase, PPAR ⁇ , TNF- ⁇ , vascular cell adhesion molecule-1 (VCAM-1), or the vitronectin receptor.
  • angiotensin converting enzyme EPO
  • factor IX factor IX
  • factor XI factor XI
  • integrin e.g., ⁇ 4
  • certain compounds of the invention do not readily cross the blood/brain barrier (e.g., less than about 5, 2.5, 2, 1.5, 1, 0.5, or 0.01 percent of compound in the blood passes into the brain).
  • the ability or inability of a compound to cross the blood/brain barrier can be determined by methods known in the art. See, e.g., Riant, P. et al., Journal of Neurochemistry 51:421-425 (1988); Kastin, A. J., Akerstrom, V., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Therapeutics 294:633-636 (2000); W. A. Banks, W. A., et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Therapeutics 302:1062-1069 (2002).
  • A is optionally substituted phenyl, biphenyl or napthyl.
  • P 1 is R 1 or a protecting group
  • P 2 is a protecting group
  • P 3 is OR 2 or a protecting group
  • X′ is, for example, O or N
  • Y 1 and Y 3 are halogen (e.g., Br, Cl) or an appropriate pseudohalide (e.g., triflate)
  • each R′ is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle, or are taken together with the oxygen atoms to which they are attached to provide a cyclic dioxaborolane (e.g., 4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolane).
  • the groups A, R 1 , R 2 , R 3 , R 6 and m are defined elsewhere herein.
  • the moieties Z′′ 1 , Z′′ 2 , Z′′ 3 , and Z′′ 4 are also defined herein, although it is to be understood that with regard to the scheme shown above, one of them is attached to the phenyl ring.
  • Z′′ 1 and Z′′ 4 may be independently CR 10 (which is defined herein), while Z′′ 2 is N and Z′′ 3 is a carbon atom bound to the adjacent phenyl ring.
  • the A moiety can be bicyclic (e.g., optionally substituted biphenyl).
  • the starting material containing A can be prepared as shown below:
  • Y 2 is halogen or pseudohalogen, and each R is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle, or are taken together with the oxygen atoms to which they are attached to provide a cyclic dioxaborolane (e.g., 4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolane).
  • a cyclic dioxaborolane e.g., 4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolane.
  • X is N, O or S
  • the cyclic moiety D can be any of a variety of structures, which are readily incorporated into compounds of the invention.
  • D is oxazole
  • Scheme 7 compounds wherein D is oxazole can be prepared as shown below in Scheme 7:
  • Pulmonary hypertension includes idiopathic and familial PH. It also includes PH associated with other diseases or conditions (e.g., collagen vascular disease, congenital systemic-to-pulmonary shunts, a drug or toxin, Gaucher disease, a glycogen storage disease, hereditary hemorrhagic telangiectasia, hemoglobinopathies, HIV infection, a myeloproliferative disorder, portal hypertension, splenectomy, a thyroid disorder). It also includes PAH and PAH associated with significant venous or capillary involvement. It also includes PH associated with pulmonary veno-occlusive disease or pulmonary capillary hemangiomatosis. It also includes persistent PH of the newborn.
  • diseases or conditions e.g., collagen vascular disease, congenital systemic-to-pulmonary shunts, a drug or toxin, Gaucher disease, a glycogen storage disease, hereditary hemorrhagic telangiectasia, hemoglobin
  • Particular methods comprise administering to a patient therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a tryptophan hydroxylase (TPH) inhibitor and at least one second active pharmaceutical ingredient.
  • Second active pharmaceutical ingredients include those that can affect vasodilation or vasoconstriction.
  • One embodiment of the invention encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of an endothelin receptor antagonist and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • endothelin receptor antagonists include those which antagonize the ET A receptor, the ET B receptor, or both the ET A and ET B receptors.
  • Particular endothelin receptor antagonists include ambrisentan, BMS-193884, bosentan, darusentan, SB-234551, sitaxsentan, and tezosentan.
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of an anticoagulant and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • anticoagulants include vitamin K antagonists (e.g., warfarin, acenocoumarol, phenprocoumon, phenindione), herparin and derivatives thereof (e.g., fondaparinux), and direct thrombin inhibitors (e.g., argatroban, bivalirudin, lepirudin, ximelagatran).
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a calcium channel blocker and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • calcium channel blockers include dihydropyridines (e.g., amlodipine, felodipine, nicardipine, nifedipine, nimodipine, nisoldipine, nitrenidipine, lacidipine, lercanidipine), phenylalkylamines (e.g., verapamil, gallopamil), benzothiazepines (e.g., diltiazem), and menthol.
  • dihydropyridines e.g., amlodipine, felodipine, nicardipine, nifedipine, nimodipine, nisoldipine, nitrenidipine, lacidi
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a prostacyclin and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • prostacyclind include epoprostenol, iloprost and treprostinil.
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of nitric oxide or a nitric oxide precursor or releasing compound, and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a phosphodiesterase 5 inhibitor and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • phosphodiesterase 5 inhibitors include sildenafil, tadalafil, and vardenafil.
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a diuretic and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • diuretics include high ceiling loop diuretics (e.g., furosemide, ethacrynic acid, torasemide, bumetanide), thiazides (e.g., hydrochlorothiazide), potassium sparing diuretics (e.g., spironolactone), and osmotic diuretics (e.g., mannitol).
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a platelet derived growth factor and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • a platelet derived growth factor is imatinib.
  • TPH inhibitor The dose and method of administration of a TPH inhibitor can be readily determined by those of ordinary skill in the art. For example, an inhibitor can be titrated until the severity of a serotonin-mediated adverse effect diminishes. Alternatively, blood 5-HT levels can be directly measured and correlated to the amount of TPH inhibitor administered.
  • compositions comprising a TPH inhibitor (e.g., a potent TPH1 inhibitor) and at least one other active pharmaceutical ingredient that can affect vasodilation or vasoconstriction.
  • TPH inhibitor e.g., a potent TPH1 inhibitor
  • other active pharmaceutical ingredients include those described herein, as well as other known by those skilled in the art.
  • compositions are single unit dosage forms suitable for oral, mucosal (e.g., nasal, sublingual, vaginal, buccal, or rectal), parenteral (e.g., subcutaneous, intravenous, bolus injection, intramuscular, or intraarterial), or transdermal administration to a patient.
  • mucosal e.g., nasal, sublingual, vaginal, buccal, or rectal
  • parenteral e.g., subcutaneous, intravenous, bolus injection, intramuscular, or intraarterial
  • transdermal administration e.g., transdermal administration to a patient.
  • dosage forms include, but are not limited to: tablets; caplets; capsules, such as soft elastic gelatin capsules; cachets; troches; lozenges; dispersions; suppositories; ointments; cataplasms (poultices); pastes; powders; dressings; creams; plasters; solutions; patches; aerosols (e.g., nasal sprays or inhalers); gels; liquid dosage forms suitable for oral or mucosal administration to a patient, including suspensions (e.g., aqueous or non-aqueous liquid suspensions, oil-in-water emulsions, or a water-in-oil liquid emulsions), solutions, and elixirs; liquid dosage forms suitable for parenteral administration to a patient; and sterile solids (e.g., crystalline or amorphous solids) that can be reconstituted to provide liquid dosage forms suitable for parenteral administration to a patient.
  • suspensions e.g., aqueous
  • the formulation should suit the mode of administration.
  • the oral administration of a compound susceptible to degradation in the stomach may be achieved using an enteric coating.
  • a formulation may contain ingredients that facilitate delivery of the active ingredient(s) to the site of action.
  • compounds may be administered in liposomal formulations in order to protect them from degradative enzymes, facilitate transport in circulatory system, and effect their delivery across cell membranes.
  • poorly soluble compounds may be incorporated into liquid dosage forms (and dosage forms suitable for reconstitution) with the aid of solubilizing agents, emulsifiers and surfactants such as, but not limited to, cyclodextrins (e.g., ⁇ -cyclodextrin, ⁇ -cyclodextrin, Captisol®, and EncapsinTM (see, e.g., Davis and Brewster, Nat. Rev. Drug Disc.
  • solubilizing agents e.g., ⁇ -cyclodextrin, ⁇ -cyclodextrin, Captisol®, and EncapsinTM (see, e.g., Davis and Brewster, Nat. Rev. Drug Disc.
  • Labrasol®, Labrafil®, Labrafac®, cremafor, and non-aqueous solvents such as, but not limited to, ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, dimethyl formamide, dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO), biocompatible oils (e.g., cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor, and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofurfuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols, fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof (e.g., DMSO:cornoil).
  • DMSO dimethyl formamide
  • biocompatible oils e.g., cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor, and sesame oils
  • glycerol tetrahydrofurfuryl
  • Nanoparticles of a compound may be suspended in a liquid to provide a nanosuspension (see, e.g., Rabinow, Nature Rev. Drug Disc. 3:785-796 (2004)).
  • Nanoparticle forms of compounds described herein may be prepared by the methods described in U.S. Patent Publication Nos. 2004-0164194, 2004-0195413, 2004-0251332, 2005-0042177 A1, 2005-0031691 A1, and U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • the nanoparticle form comprises particles having an average particle size of less than about 2000 nm, less than about 1000 nm, or less than about 500 nm.
  • composition, shape, and type of a dosage form will typically vary depending with use.
  • a dosage form used in the acute treatment of a disease may contain larger amounts of one or more of the active ingredients it comprises than a dosage form used in the chronic treatment of the same disease.
  • a parenteral dosage form may contain smaller amounts of one or more of the active ingredients it comprises than an oral dosage form used to treat the same disease. How to account for such differences will be apparent to those skilled in the art. See, e.g., Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18th ed., Mack Publishing, Easton Pa. (1990).
  • compositions of the invention suitable for oral administration can be presented as discrete dosage forms, such as, but are not limited to, tablets (e.g., chewable tablets), caplets, capsules, and liquids (e.g., flavored syrups).
  • dosage forms contain predetermined amounts of active ingredients, and may be prepared by methods of pharmacy well known to those skilled in the art. See generally, Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18th ed., Mack Publishing, Easton Pa. (1990).
  • Typical oral dosage forms are prepared by combining the active ingredient(s) in an intimate admixture with at least one excipient according to conventional pharmaceutical compounding techniques. Excipients can take a wide variety of forms depending on the form of preparation desired for administration.
  • tablets and capsules represent the most advantageous oral dosage unit forms.
  • tablets can be coated by standard aqueous or non-aqueous techniques.
  • Such dosage forms can be prepared by conventional methods of pharmacy.
  • pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms are prepared by uniformly and intimately admixing the active ingredients with liquid carriers, finely divided solid carriers, or both, and then shaping the product into the desired presentation if necessary.
  • Disintegrants may be incorporated in solid dosage forms to facility rapid dissolution. Lubricants may also be incorporated to facilitate the manufacture of dosage forms (e.g., tablets).
  • Parenteral dosage forms can be administered to patients by various routes including subcutaneous, intravenous (including bolus injection), intramuscular, and intraarterial. Because their administration typically bypasses patients' natural defenses against contaminants, parenteral dosage forms are specifically sterile or capable of being sterilized prior to administration to a patient. Examples of parenteral dosage forms include solutions ready for injection, dry products ready to be dissolved or suspended in a pharmaceutically acceptable vehicle for injection, suspensions ready for injection, and emulsions.
  • Suitable vehicles that can be used to provide parenteral dosage forms of the invention are well known to those skilled in the art. Examples include: Water for Injection USP; aqueous vehicles such as Sodium Chloride Injection, Ringer's Injection, Dextrose Injection, Dextrose and Sodium Chloride Injection, and Lactated Ringer's Injection; water-miscible vehicles such as ethyl alcohol, polyethylene glycol, and polypropylene glycol; and non-aqueous vehicles such as corn oil, cottonseed oil, peanut oil, sesame oil, ethyl oleate, isopropyl myristate, and benzyl benzoate.
  • aqueous vehicles such as Sodium Chloride Injection, Ringer's Injection, Dextrose Injection, Dextrose and Sodium Chloride Injection, and Lactated Ringer's Injection
  • water-miscible vehicles such as ethyl alcohol, polyethylene glycol, and polypropylene glycol
  • mice homozygous ( ⁇ / ⁇ ) for the disruption of tph1 were studied in conjunction with mice heterozygous (+/ ⁇ ) for the disruption of the gene, along with wild-type (+/+) litter mates.
  • mice were subject to a medical work-up using an integrated suite of medical diagnostic procedures designed to assess the function of the major organ systems in a mammalian subject.
  • TPH1 GI tract isoform of TPH
  • TPH2 brain isoform of TPH
  • TPH2 brain isoform of TPH
  • Disruption of the gene caused no measurable adverse effects on the central nervous system. This was confirmed by serotonin immunochemistry, which showed that serotonin was greatly reduced or absent in the stomach, duodenum, jejunum, ileum, cecum and colon, while serotonin levels were unaffected in raphe neurons.
  • mice homozygous ( ⁇ / ⁇ ) for the disruption of the tph1 gene had a decrease in thrombosis without a significant increase in bleeding or other adverse indications.
  • HPLC high performance liquid chromatography
  • the organic layer was separated and washed with H 2 O (2 ⁇ 100 ml), dried over Na 2 SO 4 , and concentrated in vacuo to give crude intermediate.
  • the crude compound was dissolved in 5 ml of MeCN and 5 ml of H 2 O in a 20 ml microwave reaction vial. To this solution were added L-p-borono-phenylalanine (253 mg, 1.21 mmol), sodium carbonate (256 mg, 2.42 mmol) and catalytic amount of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (42.1 mg, 0.06 mmol). The mixture was sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 5 minutes, followed by the filtration through celite.
  • (R)-1-(1-(Napthalen-2-yl)ethyl)cyanoguanidine was prepared by forming a mixture of naphthalene amine (1 equivalent), sodium dicyanide (0.95 eq.) and followed by 5N HCl (1 eq.) in n-BuOH: H 2 O (1:1). The mixture was refluxed for 1 day in a sealed tube at 160° C., and progress of reaction was monitored by LCMS. After completion of reaction, solvent (n-BuOH) was removed under reduced pressure and 1N HCl was added to adjust pH to 3-5 range. The aqueous solution was extracted with EtOAc (2 ⁇ 100) and combined organic phase was dried over Na 2 SO 4 .
  • Tetrabutylammonium fluoride (0.1 ml; 1.0 M solution in tetrahydrofuran) was added to a solution of 2-trifluoromethyl-benzaldehyde (1.74 g, 10 mmol) and trifluoromethyltrimethylsilane (TMSCF 3 ) (1.8 ml, 12 mmol) in 10 ml THF at 0° C.
  • TMSCF 3 trifluoromethyltrimethylsilane
  • the formed mixture was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for 4 hours.
  • the reaction mixture was then treated with 12 ml of 1N HCl and stirred overnight.
  • the product was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 ⁇ 20 ml).
  • the organic layer was separated and dried over sodium sulfate.
  • the organic solvent was evaporated to give 2.2 g of 1-(2-trifluoromethylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol, yield 90%.
  • Tetrabutylammonium fluoride (0.1 ml; 1.0 M solution in tetrahydrofuran) was added to a solution of 4-methyl-benzaldehyde (1.2 g, 10 mmol) and TMSCF 3 (1.8 ml, 12 mmol) in 10 ml THF at 0° C. The formed mixture was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was then treated with 12 ml of 1N HCl and stirred overnight. The product was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 ⁇ 20 ml). The organic layer was separated and dried over sodium sulfate. The organic solvent was evaporated to give 1.6 g of 1-(4-methylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol, yield 86%.
  • a microwave vial was charged with 4-chloro-2-amino-6-[1-(4-methylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidine (33 mg, 0.1 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol) and 1 ml of acetonitrile, 0.7 ml of water.
  • Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.3 ml, 1N) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II).
  • the reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes with microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness.
  • Cyclohexanecarbaldehyde (0.9 g, 5 mmol) was dissolved in 10 ml aqueous 1,4-dioxane, to which 200 mg (10 mmol) sodium borohydride was added. The reaction was run overnight at room temperature. After completion of the reaction, 5 ml 10% HCl solution was added and the product was extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic layer was separated and dried over sodium sulfate. The organic solvent was evaporated to give 0.8 g of 1-cyclohexyl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol, yield 88%.
  • a microwave vial (2 ml) was charged with 4-chloro-6-[2-fluorophenoxy]-pyrimidine, (33 mg, 0.1 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol) and 1 ml of actonitrile, 0.7 ml of water, 0.3 ml of aqueous sodium carbonate (1M) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol % of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave.
  • 3-(4-Chlorophenyl)piperidine (232 mg, 1 mmol) was added to a solution of 2,4-dichlorotriazine (149.97 mg, 1 mmol), and 300 mg diisopropylethyl amine in 10 ml THF at 0° C. The formed mixture was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for 1 hour. The product was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 ⁇ 20 ml). The organic layer was separated and dried over sodium sulfate. The organic solvent was evaporated to give 328 mg of 2-chloro-4-[3-(4-chlorophenyl)-piperidin-1-yl]-[1, 3, 5]triazine.
  • a microwave vial was charged with 2-chloro-4-[3-(4-chlorophenyl)-piperidin-1-yl]-[1,3,5]triazine (62 mg, 0.2 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (60 mg, 0.3 mmol), 1 ml of acetonitrile, and 0.7 ml of water.
  • Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.6 ml; 1M) was added to the solution, followed by 5 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II).
  • the reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes with microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness.
  • a microwave vial was charged with 4-chloro-6-[2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenyl-ethoxy]-[1,3,5]triazine-2-ylamine (33 mg, 0.1 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol), 1 ml of actonitrile, and 0.7 ml of water.
  • Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.3 ml, 1M) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II).
  • the reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness.
  • a microwave vial was charged with 6-chloro-N-[1-naphthalen-2yl-ethyl]-[1,3,5]triazine-2,4-diamine (30 mg, 0.1 mmol), 2-boc protected-amino-3- ⁇ 5-[4,4,5,5,-tetramethyl-[1,3,2]dioxaborolan-2-yl)-pyridin2-yl]-propionic acid (50 mg, 0.15 mmol) 1 ml of acetonitrile, and 0.7 ml of water.
  • Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.3 ml; 1N) was added to the solution, followed by 5 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II).
  • reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and was then purified by Prep-LC to give 7 mg of boc protected 2-amino-3- ⁇ 5-[4-amino-6-(1-naphthalen-2-yl-ethylamino)-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl]-pyridin-2-yl ⁇ proionic acid.
  • 6-Chloro-N-[1-naphthalen-2yl-ethyl]-[1,3,5]triazine-2,4-diamine (30 mg, 0.1 mmol), 2-boc-protected amino-3-[3-[4,4,5,5,-tetramethyl-[1,3,2]dioxaborolan-2-yl)-pyrazol-1-yl]-propionic acid (50 mg, 0.15 mmol), 1 ml of acetonitrile, and 0.7 ml of water.
  • Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.3 ml and 1N) was added to a microwave vial, followed by 5 mol percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II).
  • reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes with microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness, the residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and then was purified with Prep-LC to give 6.8 mg of boc protected 2-amino- ⁇ 3-[4-amino-6-(1-naphthalen-2-yl-ethylamino)[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl]-pyrazol-1-yl ⁇ proionic acid.
  • Emrys process vial (2-5 ml) for microwave was charged with (6-chloro-pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-amine (50 mg, 0.15 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol) and 2 ml of acetonitrile.
  • Aqueous sodium carbonate (2 ml, 1M) was added to the solution followed by 5 mol percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II).
  • the reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness.
  • An Emrys process vial (2-5 ml) for microwave was charged with (5-bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(4′-methyl-biphenyl-2-ylmethyl)-amine (25 mg, 0.071 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (22 mg, 0.11 mmol) and 1 ml of acetonitrile.
  • Aqueous sodium carbonate (1 ml, 1M) was added to the solution followed by 5 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II).
  • the reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness.
  • Tetrabutylammonium fluoride (TBAF: 0.1 ml, 1M) in THF was added to a solution of 3,4-difluoro-benzaldehyde (1.42 g, 10 mmol) and (trifluoromethyl)trimethylsilane (1.70 g, 12 mmol) in 10 ml THF at 0° C.
  • the mixture was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for 4 hours.
  • the reaction mixture was treated with 12 ml of 1M HCl and stirred overnight.
  • the product was extracted with dichloromethane (3 ⁇ 20 ml), the organic layer was combined and passed through a pad of silica gel. The organic solvent was evaporated to give 1.9 g of 1-(3,4-difluoro-phenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol, yield 90%.
  • reaction mixture was cooled, filtered through a syringe filter and then separated by a reverse phase preparative-HPLC using YMC-Pack ODS 100 ⁇ 30 mm ID column (MeOH/H 2 O/TFA solvent system). The pure fractions were concentrated in vacuum. The product was then suspended in 5 ml of water, frozen and lyophilized to give the title compound as a trifluoro salt (12 mg, 20%).
  • the reaction mixture was stirred at about ⁇ 40° C. for 0.5 hours, then the cold bath was removed and the temperature was allowed to rise slowly to room temperature.
  • the solvent was evaporated and the residue was extracted with hexane (4 ⁇ 20 ml). The collected extractions were washed with cold 10% aqueous NaHCO 3 and dried over Na 2 SO 4 .
  • the solvent was evaporated at reduced pressure to afford 3,5-difluorophenyl-1-trimethylsilyloxyalkene (2.03 g, 7.929 mmol, 57% crude yield), which was used in the successive reaction without further purification.
  • ammonium acetate (2.841 g, 36.896 mmol), sodium cyanoborohydride (232 mg, 3.389 mmol) and molecular sieves (3 ⁇ , 7.6 g) were added.
  • the mixture was stirred at room temperature for two days.
  • the solid was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated.
  • the residue was dissolved in water and concentrated aqueous HCl was added dropwise until the pH 2.
  • the mixture was then extracted with ethyl acetate to remove the unfinished ketone and other by-products.
  • the water layer was basified to pH ⁇ 10 with aqueous sodium hydroxide (1M), and was extracted with dichloromethane and the organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to afford 290 mg of 1-(5,7-difluoro-naphthalen-2-yl)-ethylamine (38% yield).
  • the fresh made amine (290 mg, 1.401 mmol) was added directly to a suspension of 2-amino-4,6-dichloro triazine (277 mg, 1.678 mmol) in anhydrous 1,4-dioxane (60 ml), and followed by addition of N,N-diisopropylethylamine (1 ml, 5.732 mmol).
  • the mixture was heated to mild reflux for about 3 hours.
  • the reaction mixture was then cooled, and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. To the residue was added water and the mixture was sonicated for 2-3 minutes.
  • the above-made alcohol (660 mg, 2.481 mmol) was dissolved in anhydrous 1,4-dioxane (10 ml).
  • Sodium hydride (119 mg, 60% in mineral oil, 2.975 mmol) was added all at once and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30 minutes.
  • the solution was transferred into a flask containing a suspension of 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-triazine (491 mg, 2.976 mmol) in 1,4-dioxane (70 ml). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 6 hours.
  • 5-Chloro-pyrazine-2 carboxylic acid (3,4-dimethoxy-phenyl)-amide (0.18 g, 0.61 mmol), L-p-borono phenylalanine (0.146 g, 0.70 mmol), CH 3 CN (2.5 ml), H 2 O (2.5 ml), Na 2 CO 3 (0.129 g, 1.22 mmol) were combined in a microwave vial. The mixture was sealed and kept at 150° C. for 5 minutes. The mixture was filtered and concentrated.
  • 2-Amino 4,6-dichloro pyrimidine 0.327 g, 2 mmol
  • methyl-(1-naphthalen-2yl-ethyl)-amine (0.360 g, 2 mmol)
  • cesium carbonate 0.717 g, 2.2 mmol
  • the vial was sealed and stirred at 210° C. for 20 minutes in a microwave reactor.
  • N-(biphenyl-4-ylmethyl)-5-bromopyrazin-2-amine 60 mg, 0.176 mmol
  • L-p-boronophenylalanine 37 mg, 0.176 mmol
  • palladiumtriphenylphosphine dichloride 3.6 mg, 0.0052 mmol
  • Na 2 CO 3 37 mg, 0.353 mmol
  • acetonitrile 1.25 mls
  • water 1.25 mls
  • Benzylmercaptan (0.14 g, 1.11 mmol) was treated with NaH (60% in mineral oil, 67 mg, 1.66 mmol) in dry THF (15 ml) for 30 minutes.
  • 2-Amino-4,6-dichloropyrimidine (0.2 g, 1.22 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred overnight.
  • the mixture was diluted with methylenechloride, washed with water, then brine, dried over MgSO 4 , and concentrated to give 0.11 g of 4-(benzylthio)-6-chloropyrimidin-2-amine.
  • 2-Mercaptonapthalene (0.2 g, 1.148) was treated with NaH (60% in Mineral oil, 92 mg, 2.30 mmol) in dry THF (10 ml) for 30 minutes.
  • 2-Amino-4,6-dichloropyrimidine (0.21 g, 1.26 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred overnight.
  • the mixture was diluted with methylenechloride, washed with water, then brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated to give 0.18 g 4-chloro-6-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylthio)pyrimidin-2-amine.
  • 3,5-Difluorophenyl-trifluoromethyl ketone was treated with NaBH 4 (0.18 g, 4.76 mmol) in THF (5 ml) for 2 hours. The mixture was quenched with water, extracted with methylene chloride (2 ⁇ ). The organics were combined, filtered through silica gel and concentrated to give 0.46 g of 1-(3,4-difluorophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanol.
  • tetrabutylammoniumfluoride (TBAF 1.0 N in THF 13 uL, 3.3 mg, 0.013 mmol) was added to a mixture of 3-methyl-biphenyl-2-carboxaldehyde (0.25 g, 1.27 mmol) and trifluoromethylrimethyl silane (0.25 g, 1.53 mmol), in THF (1.5 ml) at 0° C.
  • the reaction was warmed to room temperature and stirred for 4 hours.
  • HCl (3.0 N, 2.0 ml) was added, and the mixture was stirred for 3 hours.
  • the mixture was concentrated, dissolved in methylene chloride, filtered through silica gel, and concentrated to give 0.15 g of 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethanol.
  • 2,2,2-Trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethanol (0.15 g, 0.563 mmol) was treated with NaH (60% in mineral oil, 45 mg, 1.12 mmol) in dry THF (5 ml) for 30 minutes.
  • 2-Amino-4,6-dichloropyrimidine (92 mg, 0.5633 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred at 50° C. for 6 hours. The mixture was quenched with water and extracted with methylenechloride (2 ⁇ ).
  • reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 190° C. for 10 minutes with microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 10 ml of THF, to which was added 5N.HCl (5 ml). The mixture was refluxed for 2 hours in order to deprotect the benzophone and tert-butyl groups. The resulting reaction mixture was concentrated and dissolved in methanol (8 ml) and purified with Prep-LC to afford 15 mg of 2-amino-3-(4(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalene-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-trizin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid.
  • Aqueous sodium carbonate (2 ml, 1M) was added to above solution followed by 10 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II).
  • the reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 190° C. for 10 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 10 ml of THF, to which 5N.HCl (2 ml) was then added. The mixture was refluxed for 2 hours (deprotection of benzophone and tert-butyl groups).
  • Adamantane (2-yl)ethyl cyanoguanidine was prepared by forming a solution of cyanoguanidine (1 equivalent), (S)-2-amino-3-(4-cyanophenylpropanoic acid (1 equivalent) and potassium tertiary butaoxide (3.5 equivalent, Aldrich) in dry n-BuOH, which was vigorously refluxed at 160° C. in a sealed tube for 2 days. After completion of the reaction, the mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature, and the reaction was quenched with water. Solvent was removed under reduced pressure. Again, after allowing to cool to room temperature, the reaction mixture was brought to pH 12-14 by adding 1N NaOH.
  • the crude intermediate (250 mg, 0.83 mmol) was then dissolved in 6.0 ml of MeCN and 6 ml of H 2 O in a 20 ml microwave vial.
  • To this solution were added L-p-borono-phenylalanine (173.6 mg, 0.83 mmol), sodium carbonate (173.6 mg, 1.66 mmol) and catalytic amount of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (11.6 mg, 0.0166 mmol).
  • the reaction vial was then sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 7 minutes.
  • the crude intermediate (150 mg, 0.497 mmol) was then dissolved in 3.0 ml of MeCN and 3 ml of H 2 O in a 10 ml microwave vial.
  • L-p-borono-phenylalanine (104 mg, 0.497 mmol)
  • sodium carbonate 150 mg, 0.994 mmol
  • catalytic amount of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (6.9 mg, 0.00994 mmol).
  • the reaction vial was then sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 5 minutes.
  • Reaction mixture was cooled, filtered through a syringe filter and then separated by a reverse phase preparative-HPLC using YMC-Pack ODS 100 ⁇ 30 mm ID column (MeOH/H 2 O/TFA solvent system). The pure fractions were concentrated in vacuum. The product was then suspended in 5 ml of water, frozen and lyophilized to give 5 mg of pure product, 2-amino-3-[5-(5-phenyl-thiophen-2-yl)-1H-indol-3-yl]-propionic acid.
  • 1 H-NMR 300 MHz, CD 3 OD: 3.21-3.26 (m, 2H), 4.25 (q, 1H), 7.15-7.35 (m, 8H), 7.58 (d, 2H), 7.82 (d, 1H).
  • Residue was purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H 2 O/TFA as solvent system to obtain (S)-2-amino-3-[4-(2-amino-6-phenylethynyl-pyrimidin-4-yl(-phenyl]-propionic acid as a TFA salt.
  • 1 H-NMR 400 MHz, CD 3 OD: ⁇ (ppm) 3.20-3.42 (m, 2H), 4.31 (m, 1H), 7.40-7.51 (m, 6H), 7.62 (d, 2H), 8.18 (d, 2H).
  • TPH1, TPH2, tyrosine hydroxylase (TH) and phenylalanine hydroxylase (PH) were all generated using genes having the following accession numbers, respectively: X52836, AY098914, X05290, and U49897.
  • the full-length coding sequence of human TPH1 was cloned into the bacterial expression vector pET24 (Novagen, Madison, Wis., USA).
  • a single colony of BL21(DE3) cells harboring the expression vector was inoculated into 50 ml of L broth (LB)-kanamycin media and grown up at 37° C. overnight with shaking.
  • TPH1 phosphate buffered saline
  • TPH1 was purified by affinity chromatography based on its binding to pterin.
  • the cell pellet was resuspended in a lysis buffer (100 ml/20 g) containing 50 mM Tris-Cl, pH 7.6, 0.5 M NaCl, 0.1% Tween-20, 2 mM EDTA, 5 mM DTT, protease inhibitor mixture (Roche Applied Science, Indianapolis, Ind., USA) and 1 mM phenylmethanesulfonyl fluoride (PMSF), and the cells were lyzed with a microfluidizer.
  • a lysis buffer 100 ml/20 g
  • PMSF phenylmethanesulfonyl fluoride
  • the lysate was centrifuged and the supernatant was loaded onto a pterin-coupled sepharose 4B column that was equilibrated with a buffer containing 50 mM Tris, pH 8.0, 2 M NaCl, 0.1% Tween-20, 0.5 mM EDTA, and 2 mM DTT.
  • the column was washed with 50 ml of this buffer and TPH1 was eluded with a buffer containing 30 mM NaHCO 3 , pH 10.5, 0.5 M NaCl, 0.1% Tween-20, 0.5 mM EDTA, 2 mM DTT, and 10% glycerol.
  • Eluted enzyme was immediately neutralized with 200 mM KH 2 PO 4 , pH 7.0, 0.5 M NaCl, 20 mM DTT, 0.5 mM EDTA, and 10% glycerol, and stored at ⁇ 80° C.
  • TPH2 Human tryptophan hydroxylase type II
  • TH tyrosine hydroxylase
  • PAH phenylalanine hydroxylase
  • TPH1 and TPH2 activities were measured in a reaction mixture containing 50 mM 4-morpholinepropanesulfonic acid (MOPS), pH 7.0, 60 ⁇ M tryptophan, 100 mM ammonium sulfate, 100 ⁇ M ferrous ammonium sulfate, 0.5 mM tris(2-carboxyethyl)phosphine (TCEP), 0.3 mM 6-methyl tetrahydropterin, 0.05 mg/ml catalase, and 0.9 mM DTT.
  • v is the initial velocity at a given compound concentration C
  • b is the background signal
  • D is the Hill slope which is approximately equal to 1
  • I c50 is the concentration of the compound that inhibits half of the maximum enzyme activity.
  • Human TH and PAH activities were determined by measuring the amount of 3 H 2 O generated using L-[3,4- 3 H]-tyrosine and L-[4- 3 H]-phenylalanine, respectively.
  • the enzyme 100 nM was first incubated with its substrate at 0.1 mM for about 10 minutes, and added to a reaction mixture containing 50 mM MOPS, pH 7.2, 100 mM ammonium sulfate, 0.05% Tween-20, 1.5 mM TCEP, 100 ⁇ M ferrous ammonium sulfate, 0.1 mM tyrosine or phenylalanine, 0.2 mM 6-methyl tetrahydropterin, 0.05 mg/ml of catalase, and 2 mM DTT.
  • RBL2H 3 is a rat mastocytoma cell line, which contains TPH1 and makes 5-hydroxytrypotamine (5HT) spontaneously
  • BON is a human carcinoid cell line, which contains TPH1 and makes 5-hydroxytryptophan (5HTP).
  • the CBAs were performed in 96-well plate format.
  • the mobile phase used in HPLC contained 97% of 100 mM sodium acetate, pH 3.5 and 3% acetonitrile.
  • a Waters C18 column (4.6 ⁇ 50 mm) was used with Waters HPLC (model 2795).
  • a multi-channel fluorometer (model 2475) was used to monitor the flow through by setting at 280 nm as the excitation wavelength and 360 nm as the emission wavelength.
  • Cells were grown in complete media (containing 5% bovine serum) for 3-4 hours to allow cells to attach to plate wells (7K cell/well). Compounds were then added to each well in the concentration range of 0.016 ⁇ M to 11.36 ⁇ M.
  • the controls were cells in complete media without any compound present. Cells were harvested after 3 days of incubation at 37° C. Cells were >95% confluent without compound present. Media were removed from plate and cells were lysed with equal volume of 0.1N NaOH. A large portion of the cell lysate was treated by mixing with equal volume of 1M TCA and then filtered through glass fiber. The filtrates were loaded on reverse phase HPLC for analyzing 5HT concentrations. A small portion of the cell lysate was also taken to measure protein concentration of the cells that reflects the cytotoxicity of the compounds at the concentration used. The protein concentration was measured by using BCA method.
  • the average of 5HT level in cells without compound treated was used as the maximum value in the IC 50 derivation according to the equation provided above.
  • the minimum value of 5HT is either set at 0 or from cells that treated with the highest concentration of compound If a compound is not cytotoxic at that concentration.
  • Cells were grown in equal volume of DMEM and F12K with 5% bovine serum for 3-4 hours (20K cell/well) and compound was added at a concentration range of 0.07 ⁇ M to 50 ⁇ M. The cells were incubated at 37° C. overnight. Fifty ⁇ M of the culture supernatant was then taken for 5HTP measurement. The supernatant was mixed with equal volume of 1M TCA, then filtered through glass fiber. The filtrate was loaded on reverse phase HPLC for 5HTP concentration measurement. The cell viability was measured by treating the remaining cells with Promega Celltiter-Glo Luminescent Cell Viability Assay. The compound potency was then calculated in the same way as in the RBL CBA.
  • the compound was formulated in different vehicles to provide either a suspension or solution.
  • 14-week-old male C57 albino mice were dosed once daily by oral gavage at 5 ml/kg for four consecutive days. Five hours after the last dose, the animals were quickly sacrificed. Various regions of the intestinal tract and whole brain were taken and frozen immediately. 5-HT was extracted from the tissues and measured by HPLC. Blood samples were taken for exposure analysis.
  • the potent TPH1 inhibitor was found to reduce 5-HT levels in both the small and large intestine, but not in the brain.
  • the compound was formulated in H 2 O and administered to mice at four different dose levels: 15, 50, 150, and 500 mg/kg, once daily by oral gavage.
  • the compound caused significant reduction of 5-HT in the jejunum and ileum in a dose-dependent fashion.
  • the colon statistically significant reduction of 5-HT was seen at the 50, 150, and 500 mg/kg/day dose levels. No significant change of 5-HT levels was observed in the brain at any of the dose levels.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Cardiology (AREA)
  • Heart & Thoracic Surgery (AREA)
  • Pulmonology (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
  • Acyclic And Carbocyclic Compounds In Medicinal Compositions (AREA)

Abstract

Methods of treating pulmonary hypertension are disclosed. Particular methods comprise the administration of a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor and a prostacyclin. Pharmaceutical formulations are also disclosed.

Description

  • This is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/006,592, filed Jan. 14, 2011, which is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/169,815, filed Jul. 9, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 7,875,622, which claims priority to U.S. provisional application No. 60/949,040, filed Jul. 11, 2007, all of which are incorporated herein by reference.
  • 1. FIELD OF THE INVENTION
  • This invention relates to methods and compositions for the treatment of pulmonary hypertension and related diseases and disorders.
  • 2. BACKGROUND
  • Pulmonary hypertension (PH), or pulmonary arterial hypertension (PAH), is a disease characterized by increased pulmonary artery pressure and pulmonary vascular resistance. Harrison's Principles of Internal Medicine, 15th ed., pp. 1506-1507 (McGraw-Hill, 2001). Left untreated, PH “usually has a dismal prognosis culminating in right ventricular failure and death.” Ulrich, S., et al., Swiss Med. Wkly 137:73-82, 73 (2007).
  • In 2003, the World Health Organization (WHO) sponsored the development of guidelines, called the “Venice classification,” which are now used to classify types of PH. http://www.tracleer.com/default.asp?page=CouldHave WHO (accessed Jun. 29, 2007). The first type, WHO Group 1.1, is idiopathic pulmonary arterial hypertension (IPAH). This refers to PAH that occurs at random, without an apparent cause. IPAH used to be called “primary pulmonary hypertension” or PPH. Id.
  • The second type, WHO Group 1.2, is familial pulmonary arterial hypertension (FPAH). With this type of PAH, a faulty gene is passed on through the family, which causes the PAH to develop over time. It is estimated that at least 6 to 10 percent of PAH cases occur in families where at least one other person has had the disease. Id.
  • The third type, WHO Group 1.3, is pulmonary arterial hypertension associated with other diseases or conditions (APAH). This used to be called “PAH secondary to other conditions” or Secondary PAH. This category includes PAH associated with collagen vascular disease or “connective tissue disease” (e.g., scleroderma (SSc)-including CREST syndrome-lupus (SLE)), congenital systemic-to-pulmonary shunts (congenital heart disease), portal hypertension, HIV infection, drugs and toxins, and other diseases and disorders (e.g., thyroid disorders, glycogen storage diseases, Gaucher disease, hereditary hemorrhagic telangiectasia, hemoglobinopathies, myeloproliferative disorders, splenectomy). Id.
  • The fourth type, WHO Group 1.4, is pulmonary arterial hypertension associated with significant venous or capillary involvement, and includes pulmonary veno-occlusive disease (PVOD) and pulmonary capillary hemangiomatosis (PCH).
  • The fifth and final type, WHO Group 1.5, is persistent pulmonary hypertension of the newborn. Id.
  • Drugs currently used to treat PH include pulmonary vasodilators, calcium channel blockers, and inhibitors of platelet aggregation. The Merck Manual, 17th ed., pp. 1703-4 (Merck Research Laboratories, 1999). Diuretics, nitric oxide, phosphodiesterase 5 inhibitors (e.g., sildenafil) and endothelin receptor antagonists (ERAs) are also used for its treatment. Ulrich, S., et al., Swiss Med. Wkly 137:73-82, 76-77 (2007). Endothelin receptor antagonists work by binding to the ETA and/or ETB receptor sites in the endothelium and vasculature smooth muscle, thereby preventing the neurohormone endothelin-1 (ET-1) from binding to these same receptor sites and triggering vasoconstriction. Id. at 76-77. An example of an ERA is bosentan (TRACLEER®).
  • Other methods of treating PH have been investigated. For example, selective serotonin reuptake inhibitors (SSRIs) reportedly reverse PH in rats. Id. at 79. These compounds, which are widely used to treat depression, affect the reuptake of the neurotransmitter serotonin (5-HT).
  • Serotonin is synthesized in two steps from the amino acid tryptophan. Goodman & Gilman's The Pharmacological Basis of Therapeutics, 10th ed., p. 270 (McGraw-Hill, 2001). The first step is rate-limiting, and is catalyzed by the enzyme tryptophan hydroxylase (TPH), which has two known isoforms: TPH1, which is expressed in the periphery, and TPH2, which is expressed primarily in the brain. Walther, D. J., et al., Science 299:76 (2003). Mice genetically deficient for the tph1 gene (“knockout mice”) have been reported. In one case, the mice reportedly expressed normal amounts of serotonin in classical serotonergic brain regions, but largely lacked serotonin in the periphery. Id. In another, the knockout mice exhibited abnormal cardiac activity, which was attributed to a lack of peripheral serotonin. Côté, F., et al., PNAS 100(23):13525-13530 (2003). Recently, TPH knockout mice were studied in a hypoxia-induced pulmonary arterial hypertension model. Morecroft, I., et al., Hypertension 49:232-236 (2007). The results of those studies suggest that TPH1 and peripheral serotonin “play an essential role in the development of hypoxia-induced elevations in pulmonary pressures and hypoxia-induced pulmonary vascular remodeling.” Id. at 232.
  • 3. SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • This invention is directed, in part, to methods of treating pulmonary hypertension and related diseases and disorders, which comprise administering to a patient therapeutically effective amounts of a tryptophan hydroxylase (TPH) inhibitor and at least one other active pharmaceutical ingredient.
  • One embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of an endothelin receptor antagonist and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of an anticoagulant and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a calcium channel blocker and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a prostacyclin and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of nitric oxide or a nitric oxide precursor or releasing compound, and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a phosphodiesterase 5 inhibitor and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a diuretic and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a platelet derived growth factor and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • The invention also encompasses pharmaceutical formulations (e.g., single unit dosage forms) comprising a TPH inhibitor and at least one other active pharmaceutical ingredient.
  • 4. BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE FIGURE
  • Aspects of the invention may be understood with reference to the attached figure.
  • FIG. 1 shows the effects of a potent TPH1 inhibitor of the invention in the mouse gastrointestinal tract and brain after oral administration. All data are presented as percentage of the mean of the control (vehicle-dosed) group. Error bars are S.E.M. N=5 per group. The symbols are *, p<0.05 vs control group. For the brain data, p=0.5, one-way ANOVA.
  • 5. DETAILED DESCRIPTION
  • This invention is based, in part, on studies of tph1 knockout mice and the discovery of compounds that inhibit tryptophan hydroxylase (e.g., TPH1).
  • 5.1. DEFINITIONS
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “alkenyl” means a straight chain, branched and/or cyclic hydrocarbon having from 2 to 20 (e.g., 2 to 10 or 2 to 6) carbon atoms, and including at least one carbon-carbon double bond. Representative alkenyl moieties include vinyl, allyl, 1-butenyl, 2-butenyl, isobutylenyl, 1-pentenyl, 2-pentenyl, 3-methyl-1-butenyl, 2-methyl-2-butenyl, 2,3-dimethyl-2-butenyl, 1-hexenyl, 2-hexenyl, 3-hexenyl, 1-heptenyl, 2-heptenyl, 3-heptenyl, 1-octenyl, 2-octenyl, 3-octenyl, 1-nonenyl, 2-nonenyl, 3-nonenyl, 1-decenyl, 2-decenyl and 3-decenyl.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “alkyl” means a straight chain, branched and/or cyclic (“cycloalkyl”) hydrocarbon having from 1 to 20 (e.g., 1 to 10 or 1 to 4) carbon atoms. Alkyl moieties having from 1 to 4 carbons are referred to as “lower alkyl.” Examples of alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, hexyl, isohexyl, heptyl, 4,4-dimethylpentyl, octyl, 2,2,4-trimethylpentyl, nonyl, decyl, undecyl and dodecyl. Cycloalkyl moieties may be monocyclic or multicyclic, and examples include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, and adamantyl. Additional examples of alkyl moieties have linear, branched and/or cyclic portions (e.g., 1-ethyl-4-methyl-cyclohexyl). The term “alkyl” includes saturated hydrocarbons as well as alkenyl and alkynyl moieties.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “alkoxy” means an —O-alkyl group. Examples of alkoxy groups include —OCH3, —OCH2CH3, —O(CH2)2CH3, —O(CH2)3CH3, —O(CH2)4CH3, and —O(CH2)5CH3. Unless otherwise indicated, the term “alkylaryl” or “alkyl-aryl” means an alkyl moiety bound to an aryl moiety.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “alkylheteroaryl” or “alkyl-heteroaryl” means an alkyl moiety bound to a heteroaryl moiety.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “alkylheterocycle” or “alkyl-heterocycle” means an alkyl moiety bound to a heterocycle moiety.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “alkynyl” means a straight chain, branched or cyclic hydrocarbon having from 2 to 20 (e.g., 2 to 20 or 2 to 6) carbon atoms, and including at least one carbon-carbon triple bond. Representative alkynyl moieties include acetylenyl, propynyl, 1-butynyl, 2-butynyl, 1-pentynyl, 2-pentynyl, 3-methyl-1-butynyl, 4-pentynyl, 1-hexynyl, 2-hexynyl, 5-hexynyl, 1-heptynyl, 2-heptynyl, 6-heptynyl, 1-octynyl, 2-octynyl, 7-octynyl, 1-nonynyl, 2-nonynyl, 8-nonynyl, 1-decynyl, 2-decynyl and 9-decynyl.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “aryl” means an aromatic ring or an aromatic or partially aromatic ring system composed of carbon and hydrogen atoms. An aryl moiety may comprise multiple rings bound or fused together. Examples of aryl moieties include anthracenyl, azulenyl, biphenyl, fluorenyl, indan, indenyl, naphthyl, phenanthrenyl, phenyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-naphthalene, and tolyl.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “arylalkyl” or “aryl-alkyl” means an aryl moiety bound to an alkyl moiety.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the terms “biohydrolyzable amide,” “biohydrolyzable ester,” “biohydrolyzable carbamate,” “biohydrolyzable carbonate,” “biohydrolyzable ureido” and “biohydrolyzable phosphate” mean an amide, ester, carbamate, carbonate, ureido, or phosphate, respectively, of a compound that either: 1) does not interfere with the biological activity of the compound but can confer upon that compound advantageous properties in vivo, such as uptake, duration of action, or onset of action; or 2) is biologically inactive but is converted in vivo to the biologically active compound. Examples of biohydrolyzable esters include lower alkyl esters, alkoxyacyloxy esters, alkyl acylamino alkyl esters, and choline esters. Examples of biohydrolyzable amides include lower alkyl amides, α-amino acid amides, alkoxyacyl amides, and alkylaminoalkyl-carbonyl amides. Examples of biohydrolyzable carbamates include lower alkylamines, substituted ethylenediamines, aminoacids, hydroxyalkylamines, heterocyclic and heteroaromatic amines, and polyether amines.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the terms “halogen” and “halo” encompass fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “heteroalkyl” refers to an alkyl moiety (e.g., linear, branched or cyclic) in which at least one of its carbon atoms has been replaced with a heteroatom (e.g., N, O or S).
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “heteroaryl” means an aryl moiety wherein at least one of its carbon atoms has been replaced with a heteroatom (e.g., N, O or S). Examples include acridinyl, benzimidazolyl, benzofuranyl, benzoisothiazolyl, benzoisoxazolyl, benzoquinazolinyl, benzothiazolyl, benzoxazolyl, furyl, imidazolyl, indolyl, isothiazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, oxazolyl, phthalazinyl, pyrazinyl, pyrazolyl, pyridazinyl, pyridyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrimidyl, pyrrolyl, quinazolinyl, quinolinyl, tetrazolyl, thiazolyl, and triazinyl.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “heteroarylalkyl” or “heteroaryl-alkyl” means a heteroaryl moiety bound to an alkyl moiety.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “heterocycle” refers to an aromatic, partially aromatic or non-aromatic monocyclic or polycyclic ring or ring system comprised of carbon, hydrogen and at least one heteroatom (e.g., N, O or S). A heterocycle may comprise multiple (i.e., two or more) rings fused or bound together. Heterocycles include heteroaryls. Examples include benzo[1,3]dioxolyl, 2,3-dihydro-benzo[1,4]dioxinyl, cinnolinyl, furanyl, hydantoinyl, morpholinyl, oxetanyl, oxiranyl, piperazinyl, piperidinyl, pyrrolidinonyl, pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydropyridinyl, tetrahydropyrimidinyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl and valerolactamyl.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “heterocyclealkyl” or “heterocycle-alkyl” refers to a heterocycle moiety bound to an alkyl moiety.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “heterocycloalkyl” refers to a non-aromatic heterocycle.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “heterocycloalkylalkyl” or “heterocycloalkyl-alkyl” refers to a heterocycloalkyl moiety bound to an alkyl moiety.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “pharmaceutically acceptable salts” refers to salts prepared from pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic acids or bases including inorganic acids and bases and organic acids and bases. Suitable pharmaceutically acceptable base addition salts include metallic salts made from aluminum, calcium, lithium, magnesium, potassium, sodium and zinc or organic salts made from lysine, N,N′-dibenzylethylenediamine, chloroprocaine, choline, diethanolamine, ethylenediamine, meglumine (N-methylglucamine) and procaine. Suitable non-toxic acids include inorganic and organic acids such as acetic, alginic, anthranilic, benzenesulfonic, benzoic, camphorsulfonic, citric, ethenesulfonic, formic, fumaric, furoic, galacturonic, gluconic, glucuronic, glutamic, glycolic, hydrobromic, hydrochloric, isethionic, lactic, maleic, malic, mandelic, methanesulfonic, mucic, nitric, pamoic, pantothenic, phenylacetic, phosphoric, propionic, salicylic, stearic, succinic, sulfanilic, sulfuric, tartaric acid, and p-toluenesulfonic acid. Specific non-toxic acids include hydrochloric, hydrobromic, phosphoric, sulfuric, and methanesulfonic acids. Examples of specific salts thus include hydrochloride and mesylate salts. Others are well-known in the art. See, e.g., Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18th ed. (Mack Publishing, Easton Pa.: 1990) and Remington: The Science and Practice of Pharmacy, 19th ed. (Mack Publishing, Easton Pa.: 1995).
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “potent TPH1 inhibitor” is a compound that has a TPH1_IC50 of less than about 10 μM.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “prodrug” encompasses pharmaceutically acceptable esters, carbonates, thiocarbonates, N-acyl derivatives, N-acyloxyalkyl derivatives, quaternary derivatives of tertiary amines, N-Mannich bases, Schiff bases, amino acid conjugates, phosphate esters, metal salts and sulfonate esters of compounds disclosed herein. Examples of prodrugs include compounds that comprise a biohydrolyzable moiety (e.g., a biohydrolyzable amide, biohydrolyzable carbamate, biohydrolyzable carbonate, biohydrolyzable ester, biohydrolyzable phosphate, or biohydrolyzable ureide analog). Prodrugs of compounds disclosed herein are readily envisioned and prepared by those of ordinary skill in the art. See, e.g., Design of Prodrugs, Bundgaard, A. Ed., Elseview, 1985; Bundgaard, H., “Design and Application of Prodrugs,” A Textbook of Drug Design and Development, Krosgaard-Larsen and H. Bundgaard, Ed., 1991, Chapter 5, p. 113-191; and Bundgaard, H., Advanced Drug Delivery Review, 1992, 8, 1-38.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, a “prophylactically effective amount” of a compound is an amount sufficient to prevent a disease or condition, or one or more symptoms associated with the disease or condition, or prevent its recurrence. A prophylactically effective amount of a compound is an amount of therapeutic agent, alone or in combination with other agents, which provides a prophylactic benefit in the prevention of the disease. The term “prophylactically effective amount” can encompass an amount that improves overall prophylaxis or enhances the prophylactic efficacy of another prophylactic agent.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “protecting group” or “protective group,” when used to refer to part of a molecule subjected to a chemical reaction, means a chemical moiety that is not reactive under the conditions of that chemical reaction, and which may be removed to provide a moiety that is reactive under those conditions. Protecting groups are well known in the art. See, e.g., Greene, T. W. and Wuts, P.G.M., Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis (3rd ed., John Wiley & Sons: 1999); Larock, R. C., Comprehensive Organic Transformations (2nd ed., John Wiley & Sons: 1999). Some examples include benzyl, diphenylmethyl, trityl, Cbz, Boc, Fmoc, methoxycarbonyl, ethoxycarbonyl, and pthalimido.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “pseudohalogen” refers to a polyatomic anion that resembles a halide ion in its acid-base, substitution, and redox chemistry, generally has low basicity, and forms a free radical under atom transfer radical polymerization conditions. Examples of pseudohalogens include azide ions, cyanide, cyanate, thiocyanate, thiosulfate, sulfonates, and sulfonyl halides.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “selective TPH1 inhibitor” is a compound that has a TPH2_IC50 that is at least about 10 times greater than its TPH1_IC50.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “serotonin-mediated adverse effect” refers to an adverse effect that is attributable to increased levels of peripheral 5-hydroxytryptamine (5-HT).
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “stereomerically enriched composition of” a compound refers to a mixture of the named compound and its stereoisomer(s) that contains more of the named compound than its stereoisomer(s). For example, a stereoisomerically enriched composition of (5)-butan-2-ol encompasses mixtures of (S)-butan-2-ol and (R)-butan-2-ol in ratios of, e.g., about 60/40, 70/30, 80/20, 90/10, 95/5, and 98/2.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “stereoisomeric mixture” encompasses racemic mixtures as well as stereomerically enriched mixtures (e.g., R/S=30/70, 35/65, 40/60, 45/55, 55/45, 60/40, 65/35 and 70/30).
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “stereomerically pure” means a composition that comprises one stereoisomer of a compound and is substantially free of other stereoisomers of that compound. For example, a stereomerically pure composition of a compound having one stereocenter will be substantially free of the opposite stereoisomer of the compound. A stereomerically pure composition of a compound having two stereocenters will be substantially free of other diastereomers of the compound. A typical stereomerically pure compound comprises greater than about 80% by weight of one stereoisomer of the compound and less than about 20% by weight of other stereoisomers of the compound, greater than about 90% by weight of one stereoisomer of the compound and less than about 10% by weight of the other stereoisomers of the compound, greater than about 95% by weight of one stereoisomer of the compound and less than about 5% by weight of the other stereoisomers of the compound, greater than about 97% by weight of one stereoisomer of the compound and less than about 3% by weight of the other stereoisomers of the compound, or greater than about 99% by weight of one stereoisomer of the compound and less than about 1% by weight of the other stereoisomers of the compound.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “substituted,” when used to describe a chemical structure or moiety, refers to a derivative of that structure or moiety wherein one or more of its hydrogen atoms is substituted with an atom, chemical moiety or functional group such as, but not limited to, alcohol, aldehylde, alkoxy, alkanoyloxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkenyl, alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, propyl, t-butyl), alkynyl, alkylcarbonyloxy (—OC(O)alkyl), amide (—C(O)NH-alkyl- or -alkylNHC(O)alkyl), amidinyl (—C(NH)NH-alkyl or —C(NR)NH2), amine (primary, secondary and tertiary such as alkylamino, arylamino, arylalkylamino), aroyl, aryl, aryloxy, azo, carbamoyl (—NHC(O)O-alkyl- or —OC(O)NH-alkyl), carbamyl (e.g., CONH2, as well as CONH-alkyl, CONH-aryl, and CONH-arylalkyl), carbonyl, carboxyl, carboxylic acid, carboxylic acid anhydride, carboxylic acid chloride, cyano, ester, epoxide, ether (e.g., methoxy, ethoxy), guanidino, halo, haloalkyl (e.g., —CCl3, —CF3, —C(CF3)3), heteroalkyl, hemiacetal, imine (primary and secondary), isocyanate, isothiocyanate, ketone, nitrile, nitro, oxygen (i.e., to provide an oxo group), phosphodiester, sulfide, sulfonamido (e.g., SO2NH2), sulfone, sulfonyl (including alkylsulfonyl, arylsulfonyl and arylalkylsulfonyl), sulfoxide, thiol (e.g., sulfhydryl, thioether) and urea (—NHCONH-alkyl-).
  • Unless otherwise indicated, a “therapeutically effective amount” of a compound is an amount sufficient to provide a therapeutic benefit in the treatment or management of a disease or condition, or to delay or minimize one or more symptoms associated with the disease or condition. A therapeutically effective amount of a compound is an amount of therapeutic agent, alone or in combination with other therapies, which provides a therapeutic benefit in the treatment or management of the disease or condition. The term “therapeutically effective amount” can encompass an amount that improves overall therapy, reduces or avoids symptoms or causes of a disease or condition, or enhances the therapeutic efficacy of another therapeutic agent.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “TPH1_IC50” is the IC50 of a compound for TPH1 as determined using the in vitro inhibition assay described in the Examples, below.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “TPH2_IC50” is the IC50 of a compound for TPH2 as determined using the in vitro inhibition assay described in the Examples, below.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the terms “treat,” “treating” and “treatment” contemplate an action that occurs while a patient is suffering from the specified disease or disorder, which reduces the severity of the disease or disorder, or one or more of its symptoms, or retards or slows the progression of the disease or disorder.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “include” has the same meaning as “include” and the term “includes” has the same meaning as “includes, but is not limited to.” Similarly, the term “such as” has the same meaning as the term “such as, but not limited to.”
  • Unless otherwise indicated, one or more adjectives immediately preceding a series of nouns is to be construed as applying to each of the nouns. For example, the phrase “optionally substituted alky, aryl, or heteroaryl” has the same meaning as “optionally substituted alky, optionally substituted aryl, or optionally substituted heteroaryl.”
  • It should be noted that a chemical moiety that forms part of a larger compound may be described herein using a name commonly accorded it when it exists as a single molecule or a name commonly accorded its radical. For example, the terms “pyridine” and “pyridyl” are accorded the same meaning when used to describe a moiety attached to other chemical moieties. Thus, the two phrases “XOH, wherein X is pyridyl” and “XOH, wherein X is pyridine” are accorded the same meaning, and encompass the compounds pyridin-2-ol, pyridin-3-ol and pyridin-4-ol.
  • It should also be noted that if the stereochemistry of a structure or a portion of a structure is not indicated with, for example, bold or dashed lines, the structure or the portion of the structure is to be interpreted as encompassing all stereoisomers of it. Similarly, names of compounds having one or more chiral centers that do not specify the stereochemistry of those centers encompass pure stereoisomers and mixtures thereof. Moreover, any atom shown in a drawing with unsatisfied valences is assumed to be attached to enough hydrogen atoms to satisfy the valences. In addition, chemical bonds depicted with one solid line parallel to one dashed line encompass both single and double (e.g., aromatic) bonds, if valences permit.
  • 5.2. TPH INHIBITORS
  • Particular embodiments of this invention utilize compounds capable of inhibiting tryptophan hydroxylase (TPH). Preferred compounds are potent TPH1 inhibitors. Examples of potent TPH1 inhibitors are disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/638,677, filed Dec. 12, 2006.
  • Particular embodiments utilize compounds of formula I:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00001
  • and pharmaceutically acceptable salts and solvates thereof, wherein: A is optionally substituted cycloalkyl, aryl, or heterocycle; X is a bond, —O—, —S—, —C(O)—, —C(R4)═, ═C(R4)—, —C(R3R4)—, —C(R4)═C(R4)—, —C≡C—, —N(R5)—, —N(R5)C(O)N(R5)—, —C(R3R4)N(R5)—, —N(R5)C(R3R4)—, —ONC(R3)—, —C(R3)NO—, —C(R3R4)O—, —OC(R3R4)—, —S(O2)—, —S(O2)N(R5)—, —N(R5)S(O2)—, —C(R3R4)S(O2)—, or —S(O2)C(R3R4)—; D is optionally substituted aryl or heterocycle; R1 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle; R2 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle; R3 is hydrogen, alkoxy, amino, cyano, halogen, hydroxyl, or optionally substituted alkyl; R4 is hydrogen, alkoxy, amino, cyano, halogen, hydroxyl, or optionally substituted alkyl or aryl; each R5 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl or aryl; and n is 0-3.
  • Particular compounds are of formula I(A):
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00002
  • Others are of formula II:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00003
  • and pharmaceutically acceptable salts and solvates thereof, wherein: A is optionally substituted cycloalkyl, aryl, or heterocycle; X is a bond, —O—, —S—, —C(O)—, —C(R4)═, ═C(R4)—, —C(R3R4)—, —C(R4)═C(R4)—, —C≡C—, —N(R5)—, —N(R5)C(O)N(R5)—, —C(R3R4)N(R5)—, —N(R5)C(R3R4)—, —ONC(R3)—, —C(R3)NO—, —C(R3R4)O—, —OC(R3R4)—, —S(O2)—, —S(O2)N(R5)—, —N(R5)S(O2)—, —C(R3R4)S(O2)—, or —S(O2)C(R3R4)—; D is optionally substituted aryl or heterocycle; E is optionally substituted aryl or heterocycle; R1 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle; R2 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle; R3 is hydrogen, alkoxy, amino, cyano, halogen, hydroxyl, or optionally substituted alkyl; R4 is hydrogen, alkoxy, amino, cyano, halogen, hydroxyl, or optionally substituted alkyl or aryl; R5 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl or aryl; and n is 0-3.
  • Particular compounds are of formula II(A):
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00004
  • With regard to the formulae disclosed herein (e.g., I, I(A), II and II(A)), particular compounds include those wherein A is optionally substituted cycloalkyl (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered). In some, A is optionally substituted aryl (e.g., phenyl or naphthyl). In others, A is optionally substituted heterocycle (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered). Examples of 6-membered heterocycles include pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine, pyrazine, and triazine. Examples of 5-membered heterocycles include pyrrole, imidazole, triazole, thiazole, thiophene, and furan.
  • In some compounds, A is aromatic. In others, A is not aromatic. In some, A is an optionally substituted bicyclic moiety (e.g., indole, iso-indole, pyrrolo-pyridine, or napthylene).
  • Particular compounds are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00005
  • wherein: each of A1 and A2 is independently a monocyclic optionally substituted cycloalkyl, aryl, or heterocycle. Compounds encompassed by this formula include those wherein A1 and/or A2 is optionally substituted cycloalkyl (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered). In some, A1 and/or A2 is optionally substituted aryl (e.g., phenyl or naphthyl). In others, A1 and/or A2 is optionally substituted heterocycle (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered). Examples of 6-membered heterocycles include pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine, pyrazine, and triazine. Examples of 5-membered heterocycles include pyrrole, imidazole, triazole, thiazole, thiophene, and furan. In some compounds, A1 and/or A2 is aromatic. In others, A1 and/or A2 is not aromatic.
  • With regard to the formulae disclosed herein, particular compounds include those wherein D is optionally substituted aryl (e.g., phenyl or naphthyl). In others, D is optionally substituted heterocycle (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered). Examples of 6-membered heterocycles include pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine, pyrazine, and triazine. Examples of 5-membered heterocycles include pyrrole, imidazole, triazole, thiazole, thiophene, and furan. In some compounds, D is aromatic. In others, D is not aromatic. In some, D is an optionally substituted bicyclic moiety (e.g., indole, iso-indole, pyrrolo-pyridine, or napthylene).
  • With regard to the various formulae disclosed herein, particular compounds include those wherein E is optionally substituted aryl (e.g., phenyl or naphthyl). In others, E is optionally substituted heterocycle (e.g., 6-membered and 5-membered). Examples of 6-membered heterocycles include pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine, pyrazine, and triazine. Examples of 5-membered heterocycles include pyrrole, imidazole, triazole, thiazole, thiophene, and furan. In some compounds, E is aromatic. In others, E is not aromatic. In some, E is an optionally substituted bicyclic moiety (e.g., indole, iso-indole, pyrrolo-pyridine, or napthylene).
  • With regard to the various formulae disclosed herein, particular compounds include those wherein R1 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl.
  • In some, R2 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl.
  • In some, n is 1 or 2.
  • In some, X is a bond or S. In others, X is —C(R4)═, ═C(R4)—, —C(R3R4)—, —C(R4)═C(R4)—, or —C≡C—, and, for example, R4 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl. In others, X is —O—, —C(R3R4)O—, or —OC(R3R4)—, and, for example, R3 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, and R4 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl. In some, R3 is hydrogen and R4 is trifluoromethyl. In some compounds, X is —S(O2)—, —S(O2)N(R5)—, —N(R5)S(O2)—, —C(R3R4)S(O2)—, or —S(O2)C(R3R4)—, and, for example, R3 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, R4 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, and R5 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl. In others, X is —N(R5)—, —N(R5)C(O)N(R5)—, —C(R3R4)N(R5)—, or —N(R5)C(R3R4)—, and, for example, R3 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, R4 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, and each R5 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl.
  • Other compounds are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00006
  • wherein, for example, R3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are encompassed by the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00007
  • wherein, for example, R3 is hydrogen.
  • Some compounds are encompassed by the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00008
  • wherein: each of Z1, Z2, Z3, and Z4 is independently N or CR6; each R6 is independently hydrogen, cyano, halogen, OR7, NR8R9, amino, hydroxyl, or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R7 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R8 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R9 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; and m is 1-4. Certain such compounds are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00009
  • Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00010
  • wherein, for example, R3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00011
  • wherein, for example, R3 is hydrogen.
  • Referring to the various formulae above, some compounds are such that all of Z1, Z2, Z3, and Z4 are N. In others, only three of Z1, Z2, Z3, and Z4 are N. In others, only two of Z1, Z2, Z3, and Z4 are N. In others, only one of Z1, Z2, Z3, and Z4 is N. In others, none of Z1, Z2, Z3, and Z4 are N.
  • Some compounds are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00012
  • wherein: each of Z′1, Z′2, and Z′3 is independently N, NH, S, O or CR6; each R6 is independently amino, cyano, halogen, hydrogen, OR7, SR7, NR8R9, or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R7 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R8 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R9 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; and p is 1-3. Certain such compounds are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00013
  • Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00014
  • wherein, for example, R3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00015
  • wherein, for example, R3 is hydrogen.
  • Referring to the various formulae above, some compounds are such that all of Z′1, Z′2, and Z′3 are N or NH. In others, only two of Z′1, Z′2, and Z′3 are N or NH. In others, only one of Z′1, Z′2, and Z′3 is N or NH. In others, none of Z′1, Z′2, and Z′3 are N or NH.
  • Some compounds are encompassed by the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00016
  • wherein: each of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 is independently N or CR10; each R10 is independently amino, cyano, halogen, hydrogen, OR11, SR11, NR12R13, or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R11 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R12 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; and each R13 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle. Certain such compounds are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00017
  • Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00018
  • wherein, for example, R3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00019
  • wherein, for example, R3 is hydrogen.
  • Referring to the various formulae above, some compounds are such that all of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 are N. In others, only three of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 are N. In others, only two of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 are N. In others, only one of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 is N. In others, none of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 are N.
  • Some compounds are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00020
  • wherein: each of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 is independently N or CR10; each R10 is independently amino, cyano, halogen, hydrogen, OR11, SR11, NR12R13, or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R11 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; each R12 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; and each R13 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle. Certain such compounds are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00021
  • Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00022
  • wherein, for example, R3 is trifluoromethyl. Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00023
  • wherein, for example, R3 is hydrogen.
  • Referring to the various formulae above, some compounds are such that all of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 are N. In others, only three of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 are N. In others, only two of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 are N. In others, only one of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 is N. In others, none of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 are N.
  • Some are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00024
  • the substituents of which are defined herein. Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00025
  • the substituents of which are defined herein. Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00026
  • the substituents of which are defined herein. Others are of the formula:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00027
  • the substituents of which are defined herein.
  • Referring to the various formulae disclosed herein, particular compounds include those wherein both A and E are optionally substituted phenyl and, for example, X is —O—, —C(R3R4)O—, or —OC(R3R4)— and, for example, R3 is hydrogen and R4 is trifluoromethyl and, for example, n is 1. This invention encompasses stereomerically pure compounds and stereomerically enriched compositions of them. Stereoisomers may be asymmetrically synthesized or resolved using standard techniques such as chiral columns, chiral resolving agents, or enzymatic resolution. See, e.g., Jacques, J., et al., Enantiomers, Racemates and Resolutions (Wiley Interscience, New York, 1981); Wilen, S. H., et al., Tetrahedron 33:2725 (1977); Eliel, E. L., Stereochemistry of Carbon Compounds (McGraw Hill, NY, 1962); and Wilen, S. H., Tables of Resolving Agents and Optical Resolutions, p. 268 (E. L. Eliel, Ed., Univ. of Notre Dame Press, Notre Dame, 1N, 1972).
  • Particular compounds of the invention are potent TPH1 inhibitors. Specific compounds have a TPH1_IC50 of less than about 10, 5, 2.5, 1, 0.75, 0.5, 0.4, 0.3, 0.2, 0.1, or 0.05 μM.
  • Particular compounds are selective TPH1 inhibitors. Specific compounds have a TPH1_IC50 that is about 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500, or 1000 times less than their TPH2_IC50.
  • Particular compounds do not significantly inhibit human tyrosine hydroxylase (TH). For example, specific compounds have an IC50 for TH of greater than about 100, 250, 500 or 1000 μm.
  • Particular compounds do not significantly inhibit human phenylalanine hydroxylase (PAH). For example, specific compounds have an IC50 for PAH of greater than about 100, 250, 500 or 1000 μM.
  • Particular compounds of the invention do not significantly bind (e.g., inhibit with an IC50 of greater than about 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500, 750, or 1000 μM) to one or more of the following: angiotensin converting enzyme, erythropoietin (EPO) receptor, factor IX, factor XI, integrin (e.g., α4), isoxazoline or isoxazole fibrinogen receptor, metalloprotease, neutral endopeptidase (NEP), phosphatase (e.g., tyrosine phosphatase), phosphodiesterase (e.g., PDE-4), polymerase, PPARγ, TNF-α, vascular cell adhesion molecule-1 (VCAM-1), or the vitronectin receptor. The ability of a compound to bind to (e.g., inhibit) any of these targets can be readily determined using methods known in the art, as described in references cited above. Specific compounds of the invention do not inhibit cell adhesion.
  • When administered to mammals (e.g., mice, rats, dogs, monkeys or humans), certain compounds of the invention do not readily cross the blood/brain barrier (e.g., less than about 5, 2.5, 2, 1.5, 1, 0.5, or 0.01 percent of compound in the blood passes into the brain). The ability or inability of a compound to cross the blood/brain barrier can be determined by methods known in the art. See, e.g., Riant, P. et al., Journal of Neurochemistry 51:421-425 (1988); Kastin, A. J., Akerstrom, V., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Therapeutics 294:633-636 (2000); W. A. Banks, W. A., et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Therapeutics 302:1062-1069 (2002).
  • 5.3. SYNTHESIS OF TPH INHIBITORS
  • Compounds of the invention can be prepared by methods known in the art, and by methods described herein.
  • For example, with reference to formula I, compounds in which E is phenyl and D is optionally substituted pyrazine, pyridiazine, pyridine or phenyl can generally be prepared by the method shown in Scheme 1:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00028
  • wherein, for example:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00029
  • Compounds wherein X is —OCR3— can generally be prepared using the method shown in Scheme 2, wherein R3 is CF3 and D is pyrimidine:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00030
  • wherein, for example, A is optionally substituted phenyl, biphenyl or napthyl.
  • Compounds of the invention can also be prepared using the approach shown below in Scheme 3:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00031
  • wherein P1 is R1 or a protecting group; P2 is a protecting group; P3 is OR2 or a protecting group; X′ is, for example, O or N; Y1 and Y3 are halogen (e.g., Br, Cl) or an appropriate pseudohalide (e.g., triflate); and each R′ is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle, or are taken together with the oxygen atoms to which they are attached to provide a cyclic dioxaborolane (e.g., 4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolane). The groups A, R1, R2, R3, R6 and m are defined elsewhere herein. The moieties Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 are also defined herein, although it is to be understood that with regard to the scheme shown above, one of them is attached to the phenyl ring. For example, Z″1 and Z″4 may be independently CR10 (which is defined herein), while Z″2 is N and Z″3 is a carbon atom bound to the adjacent phenyl ring.
  • The individual reactions shown above can be performed using conditions known in the art. For example, palladium catalysts and conditions suitable for the Suzuki coupling of the boron and halogen-containing moieties are well known, and examples are provided below. In addition, types and appropriate uses of protecting groups are well known, as are methods of their removal and replacement with moieties such as, but not limited to, hydrogen (e.g., hydrolysis under acidic or basic conditions).
  • The A moiety can be bicyclic (e.g., optionally substituted biphenyl). In such cases, the starting material containing A can be prepared as shown below:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00032
  • wherein Y2 is halogen or pseudohalogen, and each R is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle, or are taken together with the oxygen atoms to which they are attached to provide a cyclic dioxaborolane (e.g., 4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolane).
  • Another approach to the preparation of compounds wherein D is optionally substituted pyrimidine or triazine is shown below in Scheme 4:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00033
  • wherein, for example, X is N, O or S, and FG is defined below:
    FG=B(OH)2 when E is optionally substituted Phenyl
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00034
  • when E is:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00035
  • FG=H when E is:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00036
  • Ester derivatives of these and other compounds of the invention can be readily prepared using methods such as that shown below in Scheme 5, wherein E is optionally substituted phenyl:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00037
  • An alternate approach to the preparation of triazine-based compounds is shown below in Scheme 6:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00038
  • The cyclic moiety D can be any of a variety of structures, which are readily incorporated into compounds of the invention. For example, compounds wherein D is oxazole can be prepared as shown below in Scheme 7:
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00039
  • Using methods known in the art, the synthetic approaches shown above are readily modified to obtain a wide range of compounds. For example, chiral chromatography and other techniques known in the art may be used to separate stereoisomers of the final product. See, e.g., Jacques, J., et al., Enantiomers, Racemates and Resolutions (Wiley Interscience, New York, 1981); Wilen, S. H., et al., Tetrahedron 33:2725 (1977); Eliel, E. L., Stereochemistry of Carbon Compounds (McGraw Hill, NY, 1962); and Wilen, S. H., Tables of Resolving Agents and Optical Resolutions, p. 268 (E. L. Eliel, Ed., Univ. of Notre Dame Press, Notre Dame, 1N, 1972). In addition, as shown in some of the schemes above, syntheses may utilize chiral starting materials to yield stereomerically enriched or pure products.
  • 5.4. METHODS OF USE
  • This invention is directed, in part, to methods of treating pulmonary hypertension and related diseases and disorders. Pulmonary hypertension includes idiopathic and familial PH. It also includes PH associated with other diseases or conditions (e.g., collagen vascular disease, congenital systemic-to-pulmonary shunts, a drug or toxin, Gaucher disease, a glycogen storage disease, hereditary hemorrhagic telangiectasia, hemoglobinopathies, HIV infection, a myeloproliferative disorder, portal hypertension, splenectomy, a thyroid disorder). It also includes PAH and PAH associated with significant venous or capillary involvement. It also includes PH associated with pulmonary veno-occlusive disease or pulmonary capillary hemangiomatosis. It also includes persistent PH of the newborn.
  • Particular methods comprise administering to a patient therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a tryptophan hydroxylase (TPH) inhibitor and at least one second active pharmaceutical ingredient. Second active pharmaceutical ingredients include those that can affect vasodilation or vasoconstriction.
  • One embodiment of the invention encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of an endothelin receptor antagonist and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor. Examples of endothelin receptor antagonists include those which antagonize the ETA receptor, the ETB receptor, or both the ETA and ETB receptors. Particular endothelin receptor antagonists include ambrisentan, BMS-193884, bosentan, darusentan, SB-234551, sitaxsentan, and tezosentan.
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of an anticoagulant and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor. Examples of anticoagulants include vitamin K antagonists (e.g., warfarin, acenocoumarol, phenprocoumon, phenindione), herparin and derivatives thereof (e.g., fondaparinux), and direct thrombin inhibitors (e.g., argatroban, bivalirudin, lepirudin, ximelagatran).
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a calcium channel blocker and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor. Examples of calcium channel blockers include dihydropyridines (e.g., amlodipine, felodipine, nicardipine, nifedipine, nimodipine, nisoldipine, nitrenidipine, lacidipine, lercanidipine), phenylalkylamines (e.g., verapamil, gallopamil), benzothiazepines (e.g., diltiazem), and menthol.
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a prostacyclin and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor. Examples of prostacyclind include epoprostenol, iloprost and treprostinil.
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of nitric oxide or a nitric oxide precursor or releasing compound, and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor.
  • Another encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a phosphodiesterase 5 inhibitor and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor. Examples of phosphodiesterase 5 inhibitors include sildenafil, tadalafil, and vardenafil.
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a diuretic and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor. Examples of diuretics include high ceiling loop diuretics (e.g., furosemide, ethacrynic acid, torasemide, bumetanide), thiazides (e.g., hydrochlorothiazide), potassium sparing diuretics (e.g., spironolactone), and osmotic diuretics (e.g., mannitol).
  • Another embodiment encompasses a method of treating, managing or preventing pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically or prophylactically effective amounts of a platelet derived growth factor and a tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor. An example of a platelet derived growth factor is imatinib.
  • The dose and method of administration of a TPH inhibitor can be readily determined by those of ordinary skill in the art. For example, an inhibitor can be titrated until the severity of a serotonin-mediated adverse effect diminishes. Alternatively, blood 5-HT levels can be directly measured and correlated to the amount of TPH inhibitor administered.
  • 5.5. PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS
  • This invention encompasses pharmaceutical compositions comprising a TPH inhibitor (e.g., a potent TPH1 inhibitor) and at least one other active pharmaceutical ingredient that can affect vasodilation or vasoconstriction. Examples of such other active pharmaceutical ingredients include those described herein, as well as other known by those skilled in the art.
  • Certain pharmaceutical compositions are single unit dosage forms suitable for oral, mucosal (e.g., nasal, sublingual, vaginal, buccal, or rectal), parenteral (e.g., subcutaneous, intravenous, bolus injection, intramuscular, or intraarterial), or transdermal administration to a patient. Examples of dosage forms include, but are not limited to: tablets; caplets; capsules, such as soft elastic gelatin capsules; cachets; troches; lozenges; dispersions; suppositories; ointments; cataplasms (poultices); pastes; powders; dressings; creams; plasters; solutions; patches; aerosols (e.g., nasal sprays or inhalers); gels; liquid dosage forms suitable for oral or mucosal administration to a patient, including suspensions (e.g., aqueous or non-aqueous liquid suspensions, oil-in-water emulsions, or a water-in-oil liquid emulsions), solutions, and elixirs; liquid dosage forms suitable for parenteral administration to a patient; and sterile solids (e.g., crystalline or amorphous solids) that can be reconstituted to provide liquid dosage forms suitable for parenteral administration to a patient.
  • The formulation should suit the mode of administration. For example, the oral administration of a compound susceptible to degradation in the stomach may be achieved using an enteric coating. Similarly, a formulation may contain ingredients that facilitate delivery of the active ingredient(s) to the site of action. For example, compounds may be administered in liposomal formulations in order to protect them from degradative enzymes, facilitate transport in circulatory system, and effect their delivery across cell membranes.
  • Similarly, poorly soluble compounds may be incorporated into liquid dosage forms (and dosage forms suitable for reconstitution) with the aid of solubilizing agents, emulsifiers and surfactants such as, but not limited to, cyclodextrins (e.g., α-cyclodextrin, β-cyclodextrin, Captisol®, and Encapsin™ (see, e.g., Davis and Brewster, Nat. Rev. Drug Disc. 3:1023-1034 (2004)), Labrasol®, Labrafil®, Labrafac®, cremafor, and non-aqueous solvents, such as, but not limited to, ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, dimethyl formamide, dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO), biocompatible oils (e.g., cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor, and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofurfuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols, fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof (e.g., DMSO:cornoil).
  • Poorly soluble compounds may also be incorporated into suspensions using other techniques known in the art. For example, nanoparticles of a compound may be suspended in a liquid to provide a nanosuspension (see, e.g., Rabinow, Nature Rev. Drug Disc. 3:785-796 (2004)). Nanoparticle forms of compounds described herein may be prepared by the methods described in U.S. Patent Publication Nos. 2004-0164194, 2004-0195413, 2004-0251332, 2005-0042177 A1, 2005-0031691 A1, and U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,145,684, 5,510,118, 5,518,187, 5,534,270, 5,543,133, 5,662,883, 5,665,331, 5,718,388, 5,718,919, 5,834,025, 5,862,999, 6,431,478, 6,742,734, 6,745,962, the entireties of each of which are incorporated herein by reference. In one embodiment, the nanoparticle form comprises particles having an average particle size of less than about 2000 nm, less than about 1000 nm, or less than about 500 nm.
  • The composition, shape, and type of a dosage form will typically vary depending with use. For example, a dosage form used in the acute treatment of a disease may contain larger amounts of one or more of the active ingredients it comprises than a dosage form used in the chronic treatment of the same disease. Similarly, a parenteral dosage form may contain smaller amounts of one or more of the active ingredients it comprises than an oral dosage form used to treat the same disease. How to account for such differences will be apparent to those skilled in the art. See, e.g., Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18th ed., Mack Publishing, Easton Pa. (1990).
  • 5.5.1. Oral Dosage Forms
  • Pharmaceutical compositions of the invention suitable for oral administration can be presented as discrete dosage forms, such as, but are not limited to, tablets (e.g., chewable tablets), caplets, capsules, and liquids (e.g., flavored syrups). Such dosage forms contain predetermined amounts of active ingredients, and may be prepared by methods of pharmacy well known to those skilled in the art. See generally, Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18th ed., Mack Publishing, Easton Pa. (1990).
  • Typical oral dosage forms are prepared by combining the active ingredient(s) in an intimate admixture with at least one excipient according to conventional pharmaceutical compounding techniques. Excipients can take a wide variety of forms depending on the form of preparation desired for administration.
  • Because of their ease of administration, tablets and capsules represent the most advantageous oral dosage unit forms. If desired, tablets can be coated by standard aqueous or non-aqueous techniques. Such dosage forms can be prepared by conventional methods of pharmacy. In general, pharmaceutical compositions and dosage forms are prepared by uniformly and intimately admixing the active ingredients with liquid carriers, finely divided solid carriers, or both, and then shaping the product into the desired presentation if necessary. Disintegrants may be incorporated in solid dosage forms to facility rapid dissolution. Lubricants may also be incorporated to facilitate the manufacture of dosage forms (e.g., tablets).
  • 5.5.2. Parenteral Dosage Forms
  • Parenteral dosage forms can be administered to patients by various routes including subcutaneous, intravenous (including bolus injection), intramuscular, and intraarterial. Because their administration typically bypasses patients' natural defenses against contaminants, parenteral dosage forms are specifically sterile or capable of being sterilized prior to administration to a patient. Examples of parenteral dosage forms include solutions ready for injection, dry products ready to be dissolved or suspended in a pharmaceutically acceptable vehicle for injection, suspensions ready for injection, and emulsions.
  • Suitable vehicles that can be used to provide parenteral dosage forms of the invention are well known to those skilled in the art. Examples include: Water for Injection USP; aqueous vehicles such as Sodium Chloride Injection, Ringer's Injection, Dextrose Injection, Dextrose and Sodium Chloride Injection, and Lactated Ringer's Injection; water-miscible vehicles such as ethyl alcohol, polyethylene glycol, and polypropylene glycol; and non-aqueous vehicles such as corn oil, cottonseed oil, peanut oil, sesame oil, ethyl oleate, isopropyl myristate, and benzyl benzoate.
  • 6. EXAMPLES 6.1. Production of tph1 Gene Disrupted Mice
  • Exon 3 of the murine TPH1 gene was removed by gene targeting essentially as described by Wattler et al., Biotechniques 26(6):1150-6 (1999). The resulting knockout animals displayed normal TPH activity in the brain but drastically reduced TPH expression in the gut.
  • 6.2. Physiological Effects of tph1 Gene Disruption
  • Mice homozygous (−/−) for the disruption of tph1 were studied in conjunction with mice heterozygous (+/−) for the disruption of the gene, along with wild-type (+/+) litter mates. During this analysis, the mice were subject to a medical work-up using an integrated suite of medical diagnostic procedures designed to assess the function of the major organ systems in a mammalian subject. By studying the homozygous (−/−) knockout mice in the described numbers and in conjunction with heterozygous (+/−) and wild-type (+/+) litter mates, more reliable and repeatable data was obtained.
  • Disruption of tph1 gene primarily affected the GI tract isoform of TPH (TPH1), and had little or no effect on the brain isoform of TPH (TPH2). Disruption of the gene caused no measurable adverse effects on the central nervous system. This was confirmed by serotonin immunochemistry, which showed that serotonin was greatly reduced or absent in the stomach, duodenum, jejunum, ileum, cecum and colon, while serotonin levels were unaffected in raphe neurons.
  • Mice homozygous (−/−) for the disruption of the tph1 gene had a decrease in thrombosis without a significant increase in bleeding or other adverse indications.
  • 6.3. HPLC Characterization
  • In some of the following synthetic examples, high performance liquid chromatography (HPLC) retention times are provided. Unless otherwise noted, the various conditions used to obtain those retention times are described below:
  • Method A: YMC-PACK ODS-A 3.0×50 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 4 min.; flow rate=2 ml/min; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method B: YMC-PACK ODS-A 3.0×50 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; % B from 10 to 100% over 4 min.; flow rate=3 ml/min; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method C: YMC-PACK ODS-A 3.0×50 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 5 min.; flow rate=2 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method D: Shim VP ODS 4.6×50 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 4 min.; flow rate=3 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method E: Shim VP ODS 4.6×50 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 4 min.; flow rate=3 ml/min; observation wavelength=254 nm.
  • Method F: YMC-PACK ODS-A 4.6×33 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 4 min.; flow rate=3 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method G: YMC-PACK ODS-A 4.6×50 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 2 min.; flow rate=2.5 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method H: C18 4.6×20 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 2 min. flow rate=2 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method I: YMC PACK ODS-A 3.0×50 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; B % from 10 to 100% over 4 min.; flow rate=2 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method J: YMC Pack ODS-A 3.0×50 mm; Solvent A=H2O, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=MeOH, 0.1% TFA; % B from about 10 to about 90% over 4 min.; flow rate=2 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method K: Sunfire C18 50 mm×4.6 mm×3.5 μm; Solvent A=10 mM NH4OAc in water; Solvent B=MeCN; B % from 10 to 95% over 2 min.; flow rate=4.5 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method L: Sunfire C18 50 mm×4.6 mm×3.5 μm; Solvent A=10 mM NH4OAc; Solvent B=MeCN; B % from 2 to 20% over 0.8 min, then to 95% B over 2 min; flow rate=4.5 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 nm.
  • Method M: YMC-PACK ODS-A 4.6×33 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water, 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 5 min.; flow rate=2.5 ml/min.; observation wavelength=254 nm.
  • Method N: YMC-PACK ODS-A 3.0×50 mm; Solvent A=H2O, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=MeOH, 0.1% TFA; B % from 10 to 90% over 4 min.; flow rate=2 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 and 254 nm.
  • Method O: YMC-PACK ODS-A 3.0×50 mm; Solvent A=90% water, 10% MeOH with 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=90% MeOH, 10% water with 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 4 min.; flow, rate=2 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 and 254 nm.
  • Method P: ShimPack VP ODS 4.6×50 mm; Solvent A=90% H2O, 10% MeOH, 1% TFA; Solvent B=10% H2O, 90% MeOH, 1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 2 min.; flow rate=3.5 ml/min.; observation wavelength=220 and 254 nm.
  • Method Q: Shim VP ODS 4.6×50 mm; Solvent A=H2O with 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=MeOH with 0.1% TFA; B % from 0 to 100% over 4 min.; flow rate=3 ml/min.; observation wavelength=254 nm.
  • Method R: YMC Pack ODS-A 4.6×33 mm; Solvent A=H2O, 0.1% TFA; Solvent B=MeOH with 0.1% TFA; B % from 10 to 90% over 3 min.; flow rate 2 ml/min.; observation wavelength 220 and 254 nm.
  • Method S: YMC-Pack ODS-A 3.0×50 mm; Solvent A=90% H2O, 10% MeOH, 1% TFA; Solvent B=10% H2O, 90% MeOH, 1% TFA; B % from 10 to 90% over 4 min.; flow rate=2 ml/min. observation wavelength=220 and 254 nm.
  • 6.4. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00040
  • A mixture of 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-[1,3,5]triazine (200 mg, 1.21 mmol), (R)-(+)-1-(2-naphthyl)ethylamine (207 mg, 1.21 mmol) and diisopropyl-ethylamine (3.63 mmol) was dissolved in 150 ml of 1,4-dioxane. The solution was refluxed at 90° C. for 3 hours. After the completion of reaction (monitored by LCMS), solvent was removed and the reaction mixture was extracted with CH2Cl2 (100 ml) and H2O (100 ml). The organic layer was separated and washed with H2O (2×100 ml), dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo to give crude intermediate. The crude compound was dissolved in 5 ml of MeCN and 5 ml of H2O in a 20 ml microwave reaction vial. To this solution were added L-p-borono-phenylalanine (253 mg, 1.21 mmol), sodium carbonate (256 mg, 2.42 mmol) and catalytic amount of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (42.1 mg, 0.06 mmol). The mixture was sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 5 minutes, followed by the filtration through celite. The filtrate was concentrated and dissolved in MeOH and H2O (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H2O/TFA solvent system. The combined pure fractions were evaporated in vacuo and further dried on a lyophilizer to give 238 mg of 2-amino-3-{4-[4-amino-6-(1-naphthalen-2-yl)-ethylamino)-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl]-phenyl}-propionic acid (yield: 46%, LC: Column: YMC Pack ODS-A 3.0×50 mm, % B=0˜100%, Gradient time=4 min, Flow Rate=2 ml/min, wavelength=220, Solvent A=90:10 water:MeOH w/0.1% TFA, Solvent B=90:10 MeOH:water w/0.1% TFA, RT=2.785 min, MS: M+1=429). NMR: 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 1.65 (d, 3H), 3.22-3.42 (m, 2H), 4.3 (m, 1H), 5.45 (m, 1H), 7.4 (m, 1H), 7.6 (m 4H), 7.8 (m, 4H), 8.2 (m, 2H).
  • 6.5. Alternative Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • (R)-1-(1-(Napthalen-2-yl)ethyl)cyanoguanidine was prepared by forming a mixture of naphthalene amine (1 equivalent), sodium dicyanide (0.95 eq.) and followed by 5N HCl (1 eq.) in n-BuOH: H2O (1:1). The mixture was refluxed for 1 day in a sealed tube at 160° C., and progress of reaction was monitored by LCMS. After completion of reaction, solvent (n-BuOH) was removed under reduced pressure and 1N HCl was added to adjust pH to 3-5 range. The aqueous solution was extracted with EtOAc (2×100) and combined organic phase was dried over Na2SO4. Solvent was removed in vacuo to give crude product. The compound was purified by ISCO column chromatography using as the solvent system EtOAc:hexane (7:3 and 1:1), to obtain white solid 48-71% yield for 1 g to 22.5 gram scale. NMR: 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 1.5 (d, 3H), 5.1 (m, 1H), 7.5 (m, 4H), 7.8 (s, 1H), 7.9 (m, 2H); LCMS: RT 1.69, M+1: 239, Yield: 71%.
  • The title compound was prepared from (R)-1-(1-(napthalen-2-yl)ethyl)cyanoguanidine according to the method shown in Scheme 6.
  • 6.6. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((4′-methylbiphenyl-4-yl)methylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00041
  • A mixture of 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-[1,3,5]triazine (100 mg, 0.606 mmol), 4′-methyl-biphenyl-4-yl-methylamine (142 mg, 0.606 mmol), and cesium carbonate (394 mg, 1.21 mmol) was dissolved in 1,4-dioxane (1.5 ml) and H2O (1.5 ml) in a 5 ml microwave vial. The mixture was stirred in microwave reactor at 100° C. for 15 minutes. Solvent was removed and the residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (20 ml) and washed with H2O (2×20 ml), dried over Na2SO4 and then removed in vacuo. The crude intermediate was then dissolved in 1.5 ml of MeCN and 1.5 ml of H2O in a 5 ml microwave vial. To this solution were added L-p-borono-phenylalanine (126 mg, 0.606 mmol), sodium carbonate (128 mg, 1.21 mmol) and catalytic amount of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (21.1 mg, 0.03 mmol). The mixture was sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 5 minutes followed by the filtration through celite. The filtrate was concentrated and dissolved in MeOH and H2O (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H2O/TFA solvent system. The combined pure fractions were evaporated in vacuo and further dried on a lyophilizer to give 21.6 mg of 2-amino-3-(4-{4-amino-6-[(4′-methyl-biphenyl-4-ylmethyl)-amino]-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid (LC: Column: YMC Pack ODS-A 3.0×50 mm, % B=0˜100%, Gradient time=4 min, Flow Rate=2 ml/min, wavelength=220, Solvent A=90:10 water:MeOH w/0.1% TFA, Solvent B=90:10 MeOH:water w/0.1% TFA, RT=3.096 min, MS: M+1=455). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 2.33 (s, 3H), 3.24-3.44 (m, 2H), 4.38 (m, 1H), 7.02 (d, 2H), 7.42 (m, 2H), 7.50-7.60 (m, 6H), 8.22 (m, 2H).
  • 6.7. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-morpholino-6-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00042
  • A mixture of 2,4-dichloro-6-morpholin-4-yl-[1,3,5]triazine (121 mg, 0.516 mmol), C-naphthalen-2-yl-methylamine hydrochloride (100 mg, 0.516 mmol), cesium carbonate (336 mg, 1.03 mmol) was dissolved in 1,4-Dioxane (1.5 ml) and H2O (1.5 ml) in a 5 ml microwave vial. The mixture was stirred in microwave reactor at 180° C. for 600 seconds. Solvent was removed, and the residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (10 ml) and washed with H2O (2×10 ml), dried over Na2SO4 and then in vacuo. The residue was purified by preparative HPLC to give 20 mg intermediate (yield 11%, M+1=356). The intermediate was then dissolved in 0.5 ml of MeCN and 0.5 ml of H2O in a 2 ml microwave vial. To this solution were added L-p-borono-phenylalanine (11.7 mg, 0.0562 mmol), sodium carbonate (11.9 mg, 0.112 mmol) and a catalytic amount of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (2.0 mg, 5%). The mixture was sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 5 minutes followed by the filtration through celite. The filtrate was concentrated and dissolved in MeOH and H2O (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H2O/TFA solvent system. The combined pure fractions were evaporated in vacuo and further dried on lyophilizer to give 17 mg of 2-amino-3-(4-{4-morpholin-4-yl-6-[(naphthalene-2-ylmethyl)-amino]-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid (yield: 63%, LC: Method B, RT=3.108 min, MS: M+1=486).
  • 6.8. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00043
  • Tetrabutylammonium fluoride (0.1 ml; 1.0 M solution in tetrahydrofuran) was added to a solution of 2-trifluoromethyl-benzaldehyde (1.74 g, 10 mmol) and trifluoromethyltrimethylsilane (TMSCF3) (1.8 ml, 12 mmol) in 10 ml THF at 0° C. The formed mixture was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was then treated with 12 ml of 1N HCl and stirred overnight. The product was extracted with ethyl acetate (3×20 ml). The organic layer was separated and dried over sodium sulfate. The organic solvent was evaporated to give 2.2 g of 1-(2-trifluoromethylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol, yield 90%.
  • NaH (80 mg, 60%, 3.0 mmol) was added to a solution of 1-(2-trifluoromethylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol (244 mg, 1 mmol) in 10 ml of anhydrous THF. The mixture was stirred for 20 minutes, 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-pyrimidine (164 mg, 1 mmol) was added and then the reaction mixture was heated at 70° C. for 1 hour. After cooling, 5 ml water was added and ethyl acetate (20 ml) was used to extract the product. The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed by rotovap to give 267 mg of 4-chloro-6-[2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2-trifluoromethylphenyl)-ethoxy]-pyrimidin-2-ylamine, yield 71%.
  • In a microwave vial, 4-chloro-2-amino-6-[1-(2-trifluoromethylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidine (33 mg, 0.1 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol) and 1 ml of acetonitrile, 0.7 ml of water. 0.3 ml of 1N aqueous sodium carbonate was added to above solution followed by 5 mole percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated at 150° C. for 5 minutes with microwave irradiation. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and then was purified by Prep-LC to give 5.6 mg of 2-amino-3-(4-{2-amino-6-[2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2-triifluoromethylphenyl)-ethoxy]-pyrimidin-4-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 7.96 (m, 3H), 7.80 (d, J=8.06 Hz, 1H), 7.74 (t, J=7.91 Hz 1H), 7.63 (t, J=8.06 Hz, 1H), 7.41 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 7.21 (m, 1H), 6.69 (s, 1H), 3.87 (m, 1H), 3.34 (m, 1H), 3.08 (m, 1H).
  • 6.9. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-p-tolylethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00044
  • Tetrabutylammonium fluoride (0.1 ml; 1.0 M solution in tetrahydrofuran) was added to a solution of 4-methyl-benzaldehyde (1.2 g, 10 mmol) and TMSCF3 (1.8 ml, 12 mmol) in 10 ml THF at 0° C. The formed mixture was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was then treated with 12 ml of 1N HCl and stirred overnight. The product was extracted with ethyl acetate (3×20 ml). The organic layer was separated and dried over sodium sulfate. The organic solvent was evaporated to give 1.6 g of 1-(4-methylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol, yield 86%.
  • NaH (80 mg, 60%, 3.0 mmol) was added to a solution of 1-(4-methylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol (190 mg, 1 mmol) in 10 ml of anhydrous THF. The mixture was stirred for 20 minutes, 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-pyrimidine (164 mg, 1 mmol) was added and then the reaction mixture was heated at 70° C. for 1 hour. After cooling, 5 ml water was added and ethyl acetate (20 ml) was used to extract the product. The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed by rotovap to give 209 mg of 4-chloro-6-[1-(4-methylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidin-2-ylamine, yield 66%.
  • A microwave vial was charged with 4-chloro-2-amino-6-[1-(4-methylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidine (33 mg, 0.1 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol) and 1 ml of acetonitrile, 0.7 ml of water. Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.3 ml, 1N) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes with microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, was then purified by Prep-LC to give 14.6 mg of 2-amino-3-(4-{2-amino-6-[2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-methylphenyl)-ethoxy]-pyrimidin-4-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 7.94 (d, J=8.20 Hz, 2H), 7.47 (d, J=7.24 Hz, 4H), 7.27 (d, J=8.01 Hz, 2H) 6.80 (s, 1H), 6.75 (m, 1H), 4.30 (t, 1H), 3.21-3.44 (m, 2H), 2.37 (s, 3H).
  • 6.10. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-cyclohexyl-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00045
  • Cyclohexanecarbaldehyde (0.9 g, 5 mmol) was dissolved in 10 ml aqueous 1,4-dioxane, to which 200 mg (10 mmol) sodium borohydride was added. The reaction was run overnight at room temperature. After completion of the reaction, 5 ml 10% HCl solution was added and the product was extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic layer was separated and dried over sodium sulfate. The organic solvent was evaporated to give 0.8 g of 1-cyclohexyl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol, yield 88%.
  • NaH (80 mg, 60%, 3.0 mmol) was added to the solution of 1-cyclohexyl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol (182 mg, 1 mmol) in 10 ml of anhydrous THF, the mixture was stirred for 20 minutes, 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-pyrimidine (164 mg, 1 mmol) was added and then the reaction mixture was heated at 70° C. for 1 hour. After cooling, 5 ml water was added and ethyl acetate (20 ml) was used to extract the product. The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed by rotovap to give 202 mg of 4-chloro-6-[1-cyclohexyl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidin-2-ylamine, yield 65%.
  • In a microwave vial, 4-chloro-2-amino-6-[1-cyclohexane-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidine (33 mg, 0.1 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol) and 1 ml of acetonitrile, 0.7 ml of water, 0.3 ml of aqueous sodium carbonate (1M) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes with a microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness, the residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and the product was purified by Prep-LC to give 4.9 mg 2-amino-3-{4-[2-amino-6-(1-cyclohexyl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidin-4-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3Cl) δ 7.95 (d, J=8.39 Hz, 2H), 7.49 (d, J=8.39 Hz, 2H), 6.72 (s, 1H), 5.90 (m, 1H), 4.33 (t, 1H), 3.21-3.44 (m, 2H), 1.73-2.00 (m, 6H), 1.23-1.39 (m, 5H).
  • 6.11. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(6-(2-fluorophenoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00046
  • NaH (80 mg, 60%, 3.0 mmol) was added to a solution of 2-fluorophenol (112 mg, 1 mmol) in 10 ml of anhydrous THF, the mixture was stirred for 20 minutes, 4,6-dichloro-pyrimidine (149 mg, 1 mmol) was added and then the reaction mixture was heated at 70° C. for 1 hour. After cooling, 5 ml water was added and ethyl acetate (20 ml) was used to extract the product. The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed by rotovap to give 146 mg of 4-chloro-6-(2-fluorophenoxy)-pyrimidine, yield 65%.
  • A microwave vial (2 ml) was charged with 4-chloro-6-[2-fluorophenoxy]-pyrimidine, (33 mg, 0.1 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol) and 1 ml of actonitrile, 0.7 ml of water, 0.3 ml of aqueous sodium carbonate (1M) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol % of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness, the residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and the product was purified with Prep-LC to give 4.9 mg 2-amino-3-{4-[2-amino-6-(1-2-fluorophenyl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidin-4-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.74 (s, 1H), 8.17 (d, J=8.06 Hz, 2H), 7.63 (s, 1H), 7.50 (d, J=8.06 Hz, 2H), 7.30 (m, 5H), 4.33 (m, 1H), 3.34 (m, 1H).
  • 6.12. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3 (4 (4 (3 (4 chlorophenyl)piperidin-1-yl)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00047
  • 3-(4-Chlorophenyl)piperidine (232 mg, 1 mmol) was added to a solution of 2,4-dichlorotriazine (149.97 mg, 1 mmol), and 300 mg diisopropylethyl amine in 10 ml THF at 0° C. The formed mixture was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for 1 hour. The product was extracted with ethyl acetate (3×20 ml). The organic layer was separated and dried over sodium sulfate. The organic solvent was evaporated to give 328 mg of 2-chloro-4-[3-(4-chlorophenyl)-piperidin-1-yl]-[1, 3, 5]triazine.
  • A microwave vial was charged with 2-chloro-4-[3-(4-chlorophenyl)-piperidin-1-yl]-[1,3,5]triazine (62 mg, 0.2 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (60 mg, 0.3 mmol), 1 ml of acetonitrile, and 0.7 ml of water. Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.6 ml; 1M) was added to the solution, followed by 5 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes with microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, was then purified by Prep-LC to give 5.1 mg of 2-amino-3-(4-{4-[3-(4-chlorophenyl)-piperidin-1-yl]-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3Cl) δ 8.58 (d, 2H), 8.05 (d, 2H), 7.47 (m, 5H), 4.96 (m, 1H), 4.23 (m, 2H), 3.21-3.44 (m, 4H), 2.37 (m, 5H).
  • 6.13. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenylethoxy)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00048
  • NaH (80 mg, 60%, 3.0 mmol) was added to a solution of 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenyl-ethanol (176 mg, 1 mmol) in 10 ml of anhydrous 1,4-dioxane. The mixture was stirred for 20 minutes, then added to a solution of 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-triazine (164 mg, 1 mmol) in 30 ml of 1,4-dioxane at 0° C. for 1 hour. The reaction mixture was then warmed to room temperature. After completion of the reaction, 5 ml of water was added and ethyl acetate (20 ml) was used to extract the product. The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed by rotovap to give 198 mg of 4-chloro-6-[2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenyl-ethoxy]-[1,3,5]triazine-2-ylamine, yield 65%.
  • A microwave vial was charged with 4-chloro-6-[2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenyl-ethoxy]-[1,3,5]triazine-2-ylamine (33 mg, 0.1 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol), 1 ml of actonitrile, and 0.7 ml of water. Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.3 ml, 1M) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, was then purified with Prep-LC to give 3.2 mg 2-amino-3-{4-[4-amino-6-(1-phenyl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 8.22 (d, J=8.20 Hz, 2H), 7.52 (m, 2H), 7.33 (m, 5H) 6.62 (m, 1H), 4.19 (t, 1H), 3.1-3.33 (m, 2H).
  • 6.14. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(5-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00049
  • A microwave vial was charged with 6-chloro-N-[1-naphthalen-2yl-ethyl]-[1,3,5]triazine-2,4-diamine (30 mg, 0.1 mmol), 2-boc protected-amino-3-{5-[4,4,5,5,-tetramethyl-[1,3,2]dioxaborolan-2-yl)-pyridin2-yl]-propionic acid (50 mg, 0.15 mmol) 1 ml of acetonitrile, and 0.7 ml of water. Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.3 ml; 1N) was added to the solution, followed by 5 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and was then purified by Prep-LC to give 7 mg of boc protected 2-amino-3-{5-[4-amino-6-(1-naphthalen-2-yl-ethylamino)-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl]-pyridin-2-yl}proionic acid.
  • The above product (7.0 mg) was dissolved in 0.1 ml of 10% TFA/DCM solution for 2 hours to provide 1.1 mg of 2-amino-3-{3-[4-amino-6-(1-naphthalen-2-yl-ethylamino)-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl]-pyridin-2-yl}proionic acid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3Cl) δ 9.35 (d, 1H), 8.57 (m, 1H), 7.85 (m, 4H), 7.45 (m, 4H), 6.94 (s, 1H), 5.58 (m, 1H), 4.72 (m, 2H), 4.44 (m, 1H), 1.42 (d, 3H).
  • 6.15. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(3-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-1-yl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00050
  • 6-Chloro-N-[1-naphthalen-2yl-ethyl]-[1,3,5]triazine-2,4-diamine (30 mg, 0.1 mmol), 2-boc-protected amino-3-[3-[4,4,5,5,-tetramethyl-[1,3,2]dioxaborolan-2-yl)-pyrazol-1-yl]-propionic acid (50 mg, 0.15 mmol), 1 ml of acetonitrile, and 0.7 ml of water. Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.3 ml and 1N) was added to a microwave vial, followed by 5 mol percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes with microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness, the residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and then was purified with Prep-LC to give 6.8 mg of boc protected 2-amino-{3-[4-amino-6-(1-naphthalen-2-yl-ethylamino)[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl]-pyrazol-1-yl}proionic acid.
  • The above product (6.8 mg) was stirred in 0.1 ml 10% TFA/DCM solution for 2 hours to provide 3 mg of 2-amino-3-{3-[4-amino-6-(1-naphthalen-2-yl-ethylamino)-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yl]-pyrazol-1-yl}proionic acid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, CD3Cl) δ 8.52 (s, 1H), 8.21 (s, 1H), 7.74 (m, 4H), 7.36 (m, 3H), 5.35 (m, 1H), 4.72 (m, 2H), 4.44 (m, 1H), 1.55 (d, 3H).
  • 6.16. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4′-(3-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methoxybenzylamino)biphenyl-4-yl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00051
  • Sodium triacetoxyl-borohydride (470 mg, 2.21 mmol) was added to a solution of 4-bromo-phenylamine (252 mg, 1.47 mmol) and 3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzaldehyde (324 mg, 1.47 mmol) in 10 ml of 1,2-dichloroethtane (DCE), 0.5 ml of HOAc was added. The mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature, followed by addition of 15 ml of DCE. The organic phase was washed with water and dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed by rotovap to give 656 mg of crude (4-bromo-phenyl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)amine. It was used for next step without further purification.
  • An Emrys process vial (2-5 ml) for microwave was charged with (4-bromo-phenyl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-amine (84 mg, 0.22 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (46 mg, 0.22 mmol) and 2 ml of acetonitrile. Aqueous sodium carbonate (2 ml, 1M) was added to above solution, followed by 5 mol percent of dichlorobis-(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol and purified with Prep-LC to give 5 mg of 2-amino-3-[4′-(3-cyclophentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzylamino)-biphenyl-4-yl]-propionic acid, yield 5%. 1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 1.46 (m, 2H), 1.62 (m, 4H), 3.01 (m, 2H), 3.64 (s, 3H), 4.14 (s, 3H), 4.66 (m, 1H), 6.61 (d, 2H), 6.81 (s, 2H), 6.88 (s, 1H), 7.18 (d, 2H), 7.31 (d, 2H), 7.44 (d, 2H), 7.60 (m, 1H), 8.19 (s, 3H).
  • 6.17. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(6-(3-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methoxybenzylamino)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00052
  • Sodium triacetoxyl-borohydride (985 mg, 4.65 mmol) was added to a solution of 6-chloro-pyrimidin-4-ylamine (200 mg, 1.55 mmol) and 3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzaldehyde (682 mg, 3.1 mmol) in 25 ml of DCE. 1 ml of HOAc was added, and the mixture was stirred overnight at 50° C., followed by addition of 25 ml of DCE. The organic phase was washed with water, and the product was purified with column (silica gel, hexane:EtOAc 5:1) to give 64 mg of (6-chloro-pyrimidin-4-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-amine, yield 12%.
  • An Emrys process vial (2-5 ml) for microwave was charged with (6-chloro-pyrimidin-4-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-amine (64 mg, 0.19 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (40 mg, 0.19 mmol) and 2 ml of acetonitrile. Aqueous sodium carbonate (2 ml, 1M) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol percent of dichlorobis-(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes with microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol and purified with Prep-LC to give 5.3 mg of 2-amino-3-{4-[6-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzylamino)-pyrimidin-4-yl]-phenyl}-propionic acid, yield 6%. 1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 1.46 (m, 2H), 1.62 (m, 4H), 3.01 (m, 2H), 3.08 (m, 2H), 3.65 (s, 3H), 4.20 (m, 1H), 4.46 (d, 2H), 4.68 (m, 1H), 6.82 (t, 2H), 6.87 (d, 2H), 7.40 (d, 2H), 7.90 (s, 2H), 8.25 (s, 2H), 8.6 (s, 1H).
  • 6.18. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(6-(3-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methoxybenzylamino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00053
  • Sodium triacetoxyl-borohydride (1315 mg, 6.2 mmol) was added to a solution of 6-chloro-pyrazin-2-yl-amine (400 mg, 3.10 mmol) and 3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzaldehyde (818 mg, 3.7 mmol) in 50 ml of DCE, 1 ml of HOAc was added and the mixture was stirred overnight at 50° C., followed by addition of another 50 ml of DCE. The organic phase was washed with water, and the product was purified with column (silica gel, hexane:EtOAc 6:1) to give 50 mg of (6-chloro-pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-amine, yield 10%.
  • An Emrys process vial (2-5 ml) for microwave was charged with (6-chloro-pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-amine (50 mg, 0.15 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol) and 2 ml of acetonitrile. Aqueous sodium carbonate (2 ml, 1M) was added to the solution followed by 5 mol percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and the product was purified with Prep-LC to give 5.5 mg of 2-amino-3-{4-[6-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzylamino)-pyrazin-2-yl]-phenyl}-propionic acid, yield 6%. 1H-NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 1.46 (m, 2H), 1.62 (m, 4H), 3.01 (m, 2H), 3.08 (m, 2H), 3.65 (s, 3H), 4.0 (m, 1H), 4.45 (d, 2H), 4.65 (m, 1H), 6.90 (s, 2H), 6.95 (s, 1H), 7.32 (d, 2H), 7.60 (t, 1H), 7.90 (s, 1H), 7.95 (d, 2H), 8.25 (s, 1H).
  • 6.19. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-((4′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)methylamino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00054
  • Sodium tiracetoxyl borohydride (215 mg, 1.02 mmol) was added to the solution of 4′-methyl-biphenyl-2-carbaldehyde and 5-bromo-pyrazin-2-ylamine in 5 ml of DCE, 0.1 ml of HOAc was added and the mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature, followed by addition of 5 ml of DCE. The organic phase was washed with water, and purified with column (silica gel, hexane:EtOAc 6:1) to give 100 mg of (5-bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(4′-methyl-biphenyl-2-ylmethyl)-amine, yield 55%.
  • An Emrys process vial (2-5 ml) for microwave was charged with (5-bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(4′-methyl-biphenyl-2-ylmethyl)-amine (25 mg, 0.071 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (22 mg, 0.11 mmol) and 1 ml of acetonitrile. Aqueous sodium carbonate (1 ml, 1M) was added to the solution followed by 5 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and the product was purified with Prep-LC to give 19 mg of 2-amino-3-{4-[6-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzylamino)-pyrazin-2-yl]-phenyl}-propionic acid, yield 63%. 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 2.22 (s, 3H), 3.09 (m, 1H), 3.25 (m, 1H), 4.18 (t, 1H), 4.40 (s, 2H), 7.07 (d, 2H), 7.14 (m, 3H), 7.24 (m, 4H), 7.36 (m, 1H), 7.72 (d, 2H), 7.84 (s, 1H), 8.20 (d, 1H).
  • 6.20. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenylethoxy)-pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00055
  • NaH (60%, 120 mg, 3.0 mmol) was added to a solution of 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenyl-ethanol (350 mg, 2.03 mmol) in 5 ml of THF. The mixture was stirred for 20 minutes at room temperature. 4,6-Dichloro-pyrimidine (300 mg, 2.03 mmol) was added and then the reaction mixture was heated at 70° C. for 1 hour. After cooling, the THF was evaporated to provide a residue, which was dissolved in 15 ml of EtOAc, and then washed with water, and dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed by rotovap to give 550 mg of 4-chloro-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenyl-ethoxy)-pyrimidine, yield 95%.
  • An Emrys process vial (2-5 ml) for microwave was charged with 4-chloro-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenyl-ethoxy)-pyrimidine (30 mg, 0.11 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (32 mg, 0.16 mmol), 1 ml of acetonitrile and 0.6 ml of water. Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.42 ml, 1M) was added to above solution followed by 10 mol percent of POPd2 (dihydrogen di-μ-chlorodichlorobis(di-tert-butylphosphinito-κP)dipalladate. The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 120° C. for 30 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, and the product was purified with Prep-LC to give 4.8 mg of 2-amino-3-{4-[6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenyl-ethoxy)-pyrimidin-4-yl]-phenyl}-propionic acid, yield 11%. 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 3.20 (m, 1H), 3.40 (m, 1H), 4.25 (t, 1H), 6.82 (dd, 1H), 7.43 (m, 5H), 7.57 (s, 1H), 7.60 (m, 2H), 8.10 (d, 2H), 8.75 (s, 1H).
  • 6.21. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(6-(1-(3,4-difluorophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00056
  • Tetrabutylammonium fluoride (TBAF: 0.1 ml, 1M) in THF was added to a solution of 3,4-difluoro-benzaldehyde (1.42 g, 10 mmol) and (trifluoromethyl)trimethylsilane (1.70 g, 12 mmol) in 10 ml THF at 0° C. The mixture was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was treated with 12 ml of 1M HCl and stirred overnight. The product was extracted with dichloromethane (3×20 ml), the organic layer was combined and passed through a pad of silica gel. The organic solvent was evaporated to give 1.9 g of 1-(3,4-difluoro-phenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol, yield 90%.
  • NaH (80 mg, 60%, 3.0 mmol) was added to a solution of 1-(3,4-Difluoro-phenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol (212 mg, 1 mmol) in 5 ml of THF, the mixture was stirred for 20 minutes at room temperature. 4,6-Dichloro-pyrimidine (149 mg, 1 mmol) was added and then the reaction mixture was heated at 70° C. for 1 hour. After cooling, THF was evaporated. The residue was dissolved in 15 ml of EtOAc, and then washed with water, dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed by rotovap to give 230 mg of 4-chloro-6-[1-(3,4-difluoro-phenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidine, yield 70%.
  • An Emrys process vial (2-5 ml) for microwave was charged with 4-chloro-6-[1-(3,4-difluoro-phenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyrimidine (33 mg, 0.1 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (31 mg, 0.15 mmol), 1 ml of acetonitrile and 0.7 ml of water. Aqueous sodium carbonate (0.3 ml, 1M) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol % of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 150° C. for 5 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol, then purified with Prep-LC to give 10 mg of 2-amino-3-(4-{6-[1-(3,4-difluoro-phenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy]-pyridin-4-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid, yield 21%. 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 3.11 (m, 1H), 3.27 (m, 1H), 4.19 (dd, 1H), 6.78 (q, 1H), 7.26 (m, 2H), 7.35 (d, 3H), 7.49 (m, 2H), 8.02 (d, 2H), 8.66 (s, 1H).
  • 6.22. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-(3-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methoxybenzylamino)-pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00057
  • A mixture of 3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzaldehyde (417 mg, 1.895 mmol), 2-amino-5-bromopyrazine (300 mg, 1.724 mmol), sodium triacetoxyborohydride (1.5 eq) and glacial acetic acid (3 eq) in dichloromethane (10 ml) was stirred at room temperature overnight. Then the reaction mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate, and washed with water. The organic layer was dried over MgSO4 and filtered. The filtrate was concentrated to give the crude product, which was purified by ISCO (SiO2 flash column chromatography) (Hexane/ethyl acetate=100/0 to 3/2) to give about 400 mg of 6-bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-amine. Yield: 61%.
  • To a 5 ml microwave vial, the above 6-bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-amine (50 mg, 0.132 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (30 mg, 0.144 mmol), Na2CO3 (31 mg, 0.288 mmol), acetonitrile (2 ml) and water (2 ml). Dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium (5 mg, 0.007 mmol) was added. The vial was capped and stirred at 150° C. for 5 minutes under microwave radiation. The reaction mixture was cooled, filtered through a syringe filter and then separated by a reverse phase preparative-HPLC using YMC-Pack ODS 100×30 mm ID column (MeOH/H2O/TFA solvent system). The pure fractions were concentrated in vacuum. The product was then suspended in 5 ml of water, frozen and lyophilized to give the title compound as a trifluoro salt (12 mg, 20%). 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 8.41 (s, 1H), 7.99 (s, 1H), 7.83 (d, J=9.0 Hz, 2H), 7.37 (d, J=6.0 Hz, 2H), 6.90-6.95 (m, 3H), 4.78 (m, 1H), 4.50 (s, 2H), 4.22-4.26 (m, 1H), 3.79 (s, 3H), 3.12-3.39 (m, 2H), 1.80-1.81 (m, 6H), 1.60 (m, 2H). M+1=463.
  • 6.23. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-((3-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methoxybenzyl)-(methyl)amino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00058
  • To a solution of (6-bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-amine (70 mg, 0.185 mmol) in acetonitrile (10 ml) was added formaldehyde (18.5 mmol) and sodium cyanoborohydride (17 mg, 0.278 mmol). Then, concentrated aqueous HCl was added dropwise until the pH≈2. The mixture was stirred for about 6 hours at room temperature. It was then diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with water (3×5 ml), dried over MgSO4. The solvent was removed by vacuum to give 70 mg of crude product 5-(bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-methyl-amine (95% crude yield), which was used in the next step without further purification.
  • The 5-(bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzyl)-methyl-amine (37 mg, 0.094 mmol) was subjected to a Suzuki coupling reaction as described above to afford 6 mg of the title compound. Yield: 13%. 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 8.59 (s, 1H), 8.12 (s, 1H), 7.85 (d, 2H), 7.39 (d, 2H), 6.81-6.91 (m, 3H), 4.72 (m, 1H), 4.30 (m, 1H), 3.79 (s, 3H), 3.20-3.40 (m, 2H), 3.18 (s, 3H), 3.79 (s, 3H), 1.80 (m, 6H), 1.58 (m, 2H). M+1=477.
  • 6.24. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-((1,3-dimethyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)methylamino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00059
  • A mixture of 1,3-dimethyl-1H-pyrazole-4-carbaldehyde (142 mg, 1.145 mmol), 2-amino-5-bromopyrazine (200 mg, 1.149 mmol), borane trimethylamine complex (126 mg, 1.73 mmol) and glacial acetic acid (137 mg, 2.29 mmol) in anhydrous methanol (3 ml) was stirred at room temperature overnight. The reaction mixture was then diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with water, dried over MgSO4 and filtered. The filtrate was concentrated to give 300 mg of (5-bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(1,3-dimethyl-1H-pyrazol-4-ylmethyl)amine as crude product, which was used for next step reaction without further purification. Crude yield: 93%.
  • The (5-bromo-pyrazin-2-yl)-(1,3-dimethyl-1H-pyrazol-4-ylmethyl)amine (40 mg, 0.142 mmol) was used in the Suzuki coupling reaction described above to afford 19 mg of the title compound. Yield: 36.5%. 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 8.48 (s, 1H), 8.05 (s, 1H), 7.87 (d, 2H), 7.39 (d, 2H), 6.10 (s, 1H), 4.81 (s, 2H), 4.30 (m, 1H), 3.83 (s, 3H), 3.11-3.38 (m, 2H), 2.10 (s, 3H). M+1=367.
  • 6.25. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-US)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yloxy)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00060
  • To a 250 ml flask, R-(+)-1-(2-naphthyl)ethylamine (400 mg, 2.424 mmol), 2-amino-4,6-dichloro triazine (373 mg, 2.181 mmol), anhydrous 1,4-dioxane (40 ml), and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (1 ml, 5.732 mmol) were added and heated to mild reflux for about 4 hours. The reaction was monitored carefully in order to avoid the formation of the disubstituted product. (It was observed that the longer the reaction, the more disubstituted product is formed). After 4 hours, the reaction mixture was cooled and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. Water was added to the residue, and the solution was sonicated for 2-3 minutes. The solvent was then filtered, washed with water and dried to give 540 mg (83% crude yield) of the mono-chloride, 6-chloro-N-(1-naphthalen-2yl-ethyl)-[1,3,5]triazine-2,2-diamine, which was used for the next step reaction without further purification.
  • A mixture of 6-chloro-N-(1-naphthalen-2yl-ethyl)-[1,3,5]triazine-2,2-diamine (90 mg, 0.300 mmol), 2-tert-butoxycarbonylamino-3-(4-hydroxy-phenyl)-propionic acid tert-butyl ester (102 mg, 0.303 mmol) and potassium carbonate (82 mg, 0.594 mmol) in isopropanol (8 ml) was refluxed over night. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was suspended in ethyl acetate. The solid was filtered and washed with ethyl acetate. The filtrate was concentrated and then redissolved in a mixture of methanol/water(90:10) and purified by a preparative-LC using a Sunfire C18 OBD 100×30 mm ID column (MeOH/H2O/TFA solvent system). The pure fractions were combined and concentrated to give 50 mg of pure product, 3-{4-[4-amino-6-(1-naphthalen-2-yl-ethylamino)-[1,3,5]triazin-2-yloxy]-phenyl}2-tert-butoxycarbonylamino-propionic acid tert-butyl ester, (28% yield).
  • The above product (50 mg, 0.083 mmol) was dissolved in trifluoro acetic acid/dichloromethane (8 ml/2 ml) and stirred at room temperature over night. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was then redissolved in a mixture of methanol/water(90:10) and purified by a preparative-LC using a Sunfire C18 OBD 100×30 mm ID column (MeOH/H2O/TFA solvent system). The pure fractions were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford about 4 ml, which was frozen and lyophilized to give 4 mg of the title compound as a TFA salt (11% yield). 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 7.37-7.81 (m, 8H), 7.19 (m, 2H), 6.98 (m, 1H), 5.37 (m, 1H), 4.19 (m, 1H), 3.17-3.38 (m, 2H), 1.56 (m, 3H). M+1=445.
  • 6.26. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(biphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00061
  • A mixture of 1-biphenyl-2-yl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanone (300 mg, 1.2 mmol), borane tetrahydrofuran complexes (1.2 ml, 1M in THF, 1.2 mmol) and S-2-methyl-CBS-oxazaborolidine (0.24 ml, 1M in toluene, 0.24 mmol) in THF (8 ml) was stirred at room temperature over night. Several drops of concentrated HCl were added and the mixture was stirred for 30 minutes. The product was purified by SiO2 chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate=100/0 to 3/1) to give 290 mg of 1-biphenyl-2-yl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethanol (96% yield).
  • The above alcohol (290 mg, 1.151 mmol) was dissolved in anhydrous THF (10 ml). Sodium hydride (55 mg, 1.375 mmol) was added all at once, and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30 minutes. The solution was then transferred into a flask that contained a suspension of 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-triazine (190 mg, 1.152 mmol) in THF (20 ml). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. Water was added and the mixture was then diluted with ethyl acetate. The organic layer was washed with water, dried over mgSO4 and then concentrated to give 400 mg of crude product 2-amino-4-(1-biphenyl-2-yl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy-6-chloro-triazine.
  • The 2-amino-4-(1-biphenyl-2-yl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy-6-chloro-triazine (40 mg, 0.105 mmol) was subjected to the same Suzuki coupling reaction as described above to afford 5 mg of the title compound. Yield: 9.4%. 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 8.18 (d, 2H), 7.86 (m, 1H), 7.40-7.52 (m, 9H), 7.32 (m, 1H), 7.07 (m, 1H), 4.32 (m, 1H), 3.22-3.41 (m, 2H). M+1=510.
  • 6.27. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(1-(6,8-difluoronaphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00062
  • In a three-neck flask, copper iodine (CuI) (299 mg, 1.515 mmol) and lithium chloride (LiCl) (145 mg, 3.452 mmol) were added under nitrogen to anhydrous THF (60 ml). The mixture was stirred at room temperature until a pale yellow solution was obtained. After cooling to 0° C., methyl vinyl ketone and chlorotrimethylsilane were added, and the mixture was stirred until an orange color was observed (˜20 min). After cooling to about −40° C., a solution of 3,5-difluorophenylmagnesium bromide (27.65 ml, 13.8 mmol) in THF (0.5M) was slowly added. The reaction mixture was stirred at about −40° C. for 0.5 hours, then the cold bath was removed and the temperature was allowed to rise slowly to room temperature. The solvent was evaporated and the residue was extracted with hexane (4×20 ml). The collected extractions were washed with cold 10% aqueous NaHCO3 and dried over Na2SO4. The solvent was evaporated at reduced pressure to afford 3,5-difluorophenyl-1-trimethylsilyloxyalkene (2.03 g, 7.929 mmol, 57% crude yield), which was used in the successive reaction without further purification.
  • Powered calcium carbonate (3.806 g, 38.06 mmol) and ethyl vinyl ether (2.184 g, 30.329 mmol) were added to a solution of ceric ammonium nitrate (10.430 g, 19.033 mmol) in methanol (40 ml) under nitrogen atmosphere. To the resulting suspension was added a solution of above made 3,5-difluorophenyl-1-trimethylsilyloxyalkene (2.03 g, 7.929 mmol) in ethyl vinyl (6 ml, 4.518 g, 62.75 mmol) dropwise under vigorous stirring, and the mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. The solid was filtered through a celite layer, and the filtrate was concentrated to one-fourth of its initial volume. The resulting thick mixture was slowly poured, under vigorous stirring, into 1:1 v/v diethyl ether-10% aqueous NaHCO3. The precipitate was filtered off, the ethereal solution was separated, and the solvent was evaporated at reduced pressure to give clear liquid. The solution of resulting liquid (a mixture of acyclic and cyclic acetates) in methanol (4 ml) was added dropwise to a suspension of dichlorodicyanobenzoquinone (1.77 g, 7.797 mmol) in 80% aqueous sulfuric acid at 0° C. After the addition was complete, the ice bath was removed and stirring was continued for 30 minutes.
  • The mixture was poured into ice water; and the resulting brown precipitate was filtered and dissolved in acetone. Silica gel was added to make a plug, and the crude product was purified by chromatography (hexane/ethyl acetate=100/0 to 3/1) to give 760 mg of 1-(5,7-difluoro-naphthalen-2-yl)-ethanone (48% in two-step yield) as a light yellow solid. The above ketone (760 mg, 3.689 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (40 ml). Then, ammonium acetate (2.841 g, 36.896 mmol), sodium cyanoborohydride (232 mg, 3.389 mmol) and molecular sieves (3 Å, 7.6 g) were added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for two days. The solid was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated. The residue was dissolved in water and concentrated aqueous HCl was added dropwise until the pH 2. The mixture was then extracted with ethyl acetate to remove the unfinished ketone and other by-products. The water layer was basified to pH≈10 with aqueous sodium hydroxide (1M), and was extracted with dichloromethane and the organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to afford 290 mg of 1-(5,7-difluoro-naphthalen-2-yl)-ethylamine (38% yield).
  • The fresh made amine (290 mg, 1.401 mmol) was added directly to a suspension of 2-amino-4,6-dichloro triazine (277 mg, 1.678 mmol) in anhydrous 1,4-dioxane (60 ml), and followed by addition of N,N-diisopropylethylamine (1 ml, 5.732 mmol). The mixture was heated to mild reflux for about 3 hours. The reaction mixture was then cooled, and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. To the residue was added water and the mixture was sonicated for 2-3 minutes. The resulting solid was filtered and washed with water and dried to give 395 mg (60% crude yield) of 6-chloro-N-[1-(6,8-difluoro-naphthalen-2-yl-ethyl]-[1,3,5]triazine-2,4-diamine, which was used for the next step reaction directly without further purification.
  • The above made mono-chloride (48 mg, 0.144 mmol) was subjected to the same Suzuki coupling reaction as described above to afford 12 mg of the title product. Yield: 17.9%. 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 8.14-8.22 (m, 2H), 8.05 (m, 1H), 7.92 (m, 1H), 7.63 (m, 1H), 7.32-7.51 (m, 3H), 7.11 (m, 1H), 5.48 (m, 1H), 4.13 (m, 1H), 3.13-3.41 (m, 2H), 1.66 (d, 3H). M+1=465.
  • 6.28. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00063
  • To a mixture of 3′-methyl-1-biphenyl-2-carbaldehyde (500 mg, 2.551 mmol) and trifluoromethyl trimethylsilane (435 mg, 3.061 mmol) in THF (3 ml) was added tetrabutyl ammonium fluoride (13 mg, 0.05 mmol) at 0° C. The temperature was allowed to warm to room temperature. The mixture was stirred for 5 hours at room temperature, then diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with water and brine and dried by MgSO4. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to give 660 mg (97% crude yield) of 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methyl-biphenyl-2-yl)-ethanol as crude product, which was used for next step without further purification.
  • The above-made alcohol (660 mg, 2.481 mmol) was dissolved in anhydrous 1,4-dioxane (10 ml). Sodium hydride (119 mg, 60% in mineral oil, 2.975 mmol) was added all at once and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30 minutes. The solution was transferred into a flask containing a suspension of 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-triazine (491 mg, 2.976 mmol) in 1,4-dioxane (70 ml). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 6 hours. The solvent was removed, and the residue was suspended in ethyl acetate, which was washed with water, dried over MgSO4 and then concentrated to give 790 mg of crude product, which contained about 57% of the desired product 2-amino-4-(1-(3′-methyl-biphenyl-2-yl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy-6-chloro-triazine and about 43% byproduct (the bisubstituted product). The crude product was used without further purification.
  • The 2-amino-4-(1-(3′-methyl-biphenyl-2-yl-2,2,2-trifluoro-ethoxy-6-chloro-triazine (98 mg, 57% purity, 0.142 mmol) was used to run the same Suzuki coupling reaction as described above to afford 9 mg of the title compound. Yield: 12.0%. 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 8.09 (m, 2H), 7.85 (m, 1H), 7.50 (m, 2H), 7.28-7.43 (m, 5H), 7.17-7.26 (m, 2H), 7.18 (m, 1H), 3.85 (m, 1H), 3.08-3.44 (m, 2H), 2.33 (s, 3H). M+1=524.
  • 6.29. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-(3,4-dimethoxyphenylcarbamoyl)-pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00064
  • To a mixture of 3,4-dimethoxy phenylamine (0.306 g, 2 mmol) and triethylamine (0.557 ml, 4 mmol) in dichloromethane (20 ml) was added 5-chloro-pyrazine-2-carbonyl chloride (0.354 g, 2 mmol) at 0-5° C. The mixture was allowed to stir at room temperature for 3 hours. The mixture was diluted with methylene chloride (20 ml), washed with saturated NaHCO3 (20 ml), brine (20 ml), dried (anhyd. Na2SO4) and concentrated to get 0.42 g of crude 5-chloro-pyrazine-2 carboxylic acid (3,4-dimethoxy-phenyl)-amide, which was directly used in the next reaction.
  • 5-Chloro-pyrazine-2 carboxylic acid (3,4-dimethoxy-phenyl)-amide (0.18 g, 0.61 mmol), L-p-borono phenylalanine (0.146 g, 0.70 mmol), CH3CN (2.5 ml), H2O (2.5 ml), Na2CO3 (0.129 g, 1.22 mmol) were combined in a microwave vial. The mixture was sealed and kept at 150° C. for 5 minutes. The mixture was filtered and concentrated. The residue was dissolved in methanol/water (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC, using MeOH/H2O/TFA as solvent system to afford 2-amino-3-{4-[5-(3,4-dimethoxy-phenylcarbornyl)-pyrazin-2-yl]-phenyl}-propionic acid as a TFA salt (HPLC: Method A, Retention time=2.846 min, LCMS M+1 423). 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 3.10-3.30 (m, 2H), 3.72 (d, 6H), 4.05 (m, 1H), 7.42-7.62 (m, 4H), 8.22 (m, 3H), 9.30 (m, 2H).
  • 6.30. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(4-(2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl)-piperidin-1-yl)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00065
  • 2-Amino 4,6-dichloro pyrimidine (0.164 g, 1 mmol), 4-(2-trifluoromethyl-phenyl)-piperidine hydrochloride (0.266 g, 1 mmol), and cesium carbonate (0.684 g, 2.1 mmol) were dissolved in a mixture of 1,4-dioxane (5 ml) and H2O (5 ml) in a 20 ml microwave vial. The mixture was stirred at 210° C. for 20 minutes in a microwave reactor. Solvent was removed and the residue was dissolved in 5% methanol in CH2Cl2 (20 ml), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated to get the crude intermediate, 4-chloro-6-[4-(2-trifluoromethyl-phenyl)-piperidin-1-yl]-pyrimidin-2-ylamine (0.42 g) which was directly used in the following step.
  • The crude intermediate (0.42 g), L-p-borono-phenylalanine (0.209 g, 1 mmol), sodium carbonate (0.210 g, 2 mmol), and dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (35 mg, 0.05 mmol) were dissolved in a mixture of MeCN (2.5 ml) and H2O (2.5 ml) in a 10 ml microwave vial. The vial was sealed and stirred in a microwave reactor at 150° C. for 6 minutes. The mixture was filtered, and the filtrate was concentrated. The residue was dissolved in MeOH and H2O (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H2O/TFA as the solvent system to afford 2-amino-3-(4-{4-(2-trifluoromethyl-phenyl)-piperidine-1-yl]-pyrimidin-4yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid as a TFA salt. HPLC: Method A, Retention time=3.203 min. LCMS M+1 486. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.80-2.20 (m, 5H), 3.0-3.16 (m, 2H), 3.22-3.42 (m, 2H), 4.22 (t, 1H), 4.42-4.54 (m, 1H), 5.22-5.34 (m, 1H), 6.80 (s, 1H), 7.40 (t, 1H), 7.50-7.60 (m, 4H), 7.68 (d, 1H), 7.82 (d, 2H).
  • 6.31. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00066
  • 2-Amino 4,6-dichloro pyrimidine (0.164 g, 1 mmol), (R)-(+)-1-(2-naphthyl)-ethylamine (0.171 g, 1 mmol), and cesium carbonate (0.358 g, 1.1 mmol) were dissolved in a mixture of 1,4-dioxane (4 ml) and H2O (4 ml) in a 20 ml microwave vial. The vial was sealed and stirred at 210° C. for 20 minutes in a microwave reactor. Solvent was removed and the residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (50 ml), washed with water (20 ml), brine (20 ml), dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to afford the crude intermediate, 6-chloro-N-4-(naphthalene-2yl-ethyl)-pyrimidine-2,4-diamine (0.270 g) which was directly used in the following step.
  • The crude intermediate (0.27 g), L-p-borono-phenylalanine (0.210 g, 1 mmol), sodium carbonate (0.210 g, 2 mmol), and dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (25 mg, 0.036 mmol) were dissolved in a mixture of MeCN (2.5 ml) and H2O (2.5 ml) in a microwave vial. The vial was sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 6 minutes. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated. The residue was dissolved in MeOH and H2O (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H2O/TFA as the solvent system to afford 2 amino-3-{4-[2-amino-6-(1-naphthalen-2yl-ethylamino)-pyrimidin-4-yl]-phenyl}-propionic acid as a TFA salt. HPLC: Method A, Retention time=3.276 min. LCMS M+1 428. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.68 (d, 3H), 3.22-3.40 (m, 2H), 4.30 (t, 1H), 5.60 (q, 1H), 6.42 (s, 1H), 7.42-7.54 (m, 5H), 7.72 (m, 2H), 7.82-7.84 (m, 4H).
  • 6.32. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(methyl((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethyl)amino)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00067
  • 2-Amino 4,6-dichloro pyrimidine (0.327 g, 2 mmol), methyl-(1-naphthalen-2yl-ethyl)-amine (0.360 g, 2 mmol), and cesium carbonate (0.717 g, 2.2 mmol) were dissolved in a mixture of 1,4-dioxane (7.5 ml) and H2O (7.5 ml) in a 20 ml microwave vial. The vial was sealed and stirred at 210° C. for 20 minutes in a microwave reactor. Solvent was removed and the residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (50 ml), washed with water (20 ml), brine (20 ml) dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to get the crude intermediate, 6-chloro-N-4-methyl-N-4-(1-napthalen-2-yl-ethyl)-pyrimidine-2,4-diamine (0.600 g), which was directly used in the following step.
  • The crude intermediate (0.30 g), L-p-borono-phenylalanine (0.210 g, 1 mmol), sodium carbonate (0.210 g, 2 mmol), and dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (25 mg, 0.036 mmol) were dissolved in a mixture of MeCN (2.5 ml) and H2O (2.5 ml) in a microwave vial. The vial was sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 6 minutes. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated. The residue was dissolved in MeOH and H2O (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H2O/TFA as the solvent system to afford 2-amino-3-(4-{2-amino-6-[methyl-(1-naphthalen-2yl-ethyl)amino]-pyrimidin-4-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid as a TFA salt (HPLC: Method C, Retention time=2.945 min, LCMS M+1 442) 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.70 (m, 3H), 2.92 (s, 3H), 3.22-3.42 (m, 2H), 4.28 (m, 1H), 6.60 (s, 1H), 6.72 (m, 1H), 7.40-7.92 (m, 11H).
  • 6.33. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((S)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(6-methoxynaphthalen-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00068
  • 2-Amino 4,6-dichloro pyrimidine (0.096 g, 0.6 mmol), 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(6-methoxy-naphthalen-2-yl)-ethanol (0.140 g, 0.55 mmol), and NaH (96 mg, 0.60 mmol) were added to anhydrous dioxane (20 ml) under a nitrogen atmosphere. The reaction was stirred at 80° C. for 12 hours, cooled to room temperature, and quenched with water (0.2 ml). The reaction mixture was concentrated, and the residue dissolved in CH2Cl2 (50 ml), washed with water (20 ml), brine (20 ml) dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to afford the crude intermediate, 4-chloro-6-[2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(6-methoxy-naphthalene-2-yl)-ethoxy]-pyrimidin-2-ylamine (0.22 g) which was directly used in the following step.
  • The crude intermediate (0.22 g), L-p-borono-phenylalanine (0.126 g, 0.6 mmol), sodium carbonate (0.126 g, 1.2 mmol), and dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (15 mg, 0.021 mmol) were dissolved in a mixture of MeCN (2.0 ml) and H2O (2.0 ml) in a microwave vial. The vial was sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 6 minutes. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated. The residue was dissolved in MeOH and H2O (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H2O/TFA as the solvent system to afford 2-amino-3-(4-{2-amino-6-[2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(6-methoxy-naphthalen-2-yl)-ethoxy]-pyrimidin-4-yl}-phenyl)-propionic acid as a TFA salt (HPLC: Method C, Retention time=3.190 min. LCMS M+1 513. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 3.22-3.42 (m, 2H), 3.86 (s, 3H), 4.32 (1H), 6.88 (m, 1H), 6.92 (1H), 7.20 (dd, 1H), 7.26 (s, 1H), 7.50 (d, 2H), 7.63 (d, 1H), 7.80-7.90 (m, 4H), 8.05 (s, 1H).
  • 6.34. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-(biphenyl-4-ylmethylamino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00069
  • 4-Phenylbenzaldehyde (0.3 g, 1.65 mmol) and 2-amino-5-bromopyrazine (0.24 g, 1.37 mmol) were treated with Na(OAc)3BH (0.44 g, 2.06 mmol) in dichloroethane (7.0 mls) and acetic acid (0.25 mls) for 18 hours at room temperature. The mixture was diluted with dichloromethane, washed with 1.0 N NaOH, washed with brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated. Chromatography (SiO2, EtOAc: Hex, 1:1) gave 0.18 g of N-(biphenyl-4-ylmethyl)-5-bromopyrazin-2-amine.
  • N-(biphenyl-4-ylmethyl)-5-bromopyrazin-2-amine (60 mg, 0.176 mmol), L-p-boronophenylalanine (37 mg, 0.176 mmol), palladiumtriphenylphosphine dichloride (3.6 mg, 0.0052 mmol), Na2CO3 (37 mg, 0.353 mmol), acetonitrile (1.25 mls) and water (1.25 mls) were heated in a microwave reactor at 150° C. for 5 minutes. The mixture was concentrated, dissolved in 1.0 N HCl, washed twice with ether, concentrated and purified by preprative HPLC to give 41 mgs of the title compound. M+1=425; 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 8.42 (s, 1H), 8.05 (s, 1H), 7.92 (d, 2H), 7.58 (d, 4H), 7.40 (m, 7H), 4.60 (s, 2H), 4.25 (m, 1H), 3.40 (m, 1H), 3.20 (m, 1H).
  • 6.35. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylamino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00070
  • 2-Napthaldehyde (0.6 g, 3.84 mmol) and 2-amino-5-bromopyrazine (0.56 g, 3.201 mmol) were treated with Na(OAc)3BH (1.02 g, 4.802 mmol) in dichloroethane (15.0 mls) and acetic acid (0.5 mls) for 18 hours at room temperature. The mixture was diluted with dichloromethane, washed with 1.0 N NaOH, washed with brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated. Chromatography (SiO2, EtOAc: Hex, 1:1) gave 0.49 g 5-bromo-N-(naphthalen-2-ylmethyl)pyrazin-2-amine.
  • 5-Bromo-N-(naphthalen-2-ylmethyl)pyrazin-2-amine (0.2 g, 0.637 mmol), L-p-boronophenylalanine (0.13 g, 0.637 mmol), palladiumtriphenylphosphine dichloride (13 mg, 0.019 mmol), Na2CO3 (0.13 g, 1.27 mmol), acetonitrile (5 mls) and water (5 mls) were heated in a microwave reactor at 150° C. for 5 minutes. The mixture was concentrated, dissolved in 1.0 N HCl, washed twice with ether, concentrated, dissolved in methanol, filtered and concentrated to yield 0.12 g of the captioned compound. M+1=399; 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 8.51 (s, 1H), 8.37 (s, 1H), 7.90 (m, 6H), 7.50 (m, 5H), 4.85 (s, 2H), 4.30 (t, 1H), 3.38 (m, 1H), 3.22 (m, 1H).
  • 6.36. Synthesis of (S)-2-(Tert-butoxycarbonylamino)-3-(4-(5-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylamino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00071
  • (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylamino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid (0.15 g, 0.345 mmol) was treated with triethylamine (87 mg, 0.862 mmol), and boc-anhydride (84 mg, 0.379) in dioxane (3 ml) and H2O (3 ml) at 0° C. The mixture was warmed to room temperature and stirred overnight. The mixture was concentrated, and partitioned between EtOAc and H2O. The aqueous phase was acidified to pH=1 with 1.0 N HCl and extracted with EtOAc. The organics were combined, washed with brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated to yield 48 mg of the captioned compound.
  • 6.37. Synthesis of (S)-2-Morpholinoethyl 2-amino-3-(4-(5-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylamino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoate
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00072
  • (S)-2-(Tert-butoxycarbonylamino)-3-(4-(5-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylamino)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid (48 mg, 0.090 mmol), 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)morpholine (12 mg, 0.090 mmol), triethylamine (18 mg, 0.180 mmol), and benzotriazole-1-yloxytris(dimethylamino)-phosphonium hexafluorophosphate (BOP, 18 mg, 0.090 mmol), in dichloromethane (3.0 ml) were stirred at room temperature for 5 hours. Additional triethylamine (18 mg, 0.180 mmol) and BOP (18 mg, 0.090 mmol) were added, and the mixture was stirred overnight. The mixture was concentrated and purified via prep HPLC to give 2 mg of the captioned compound.
  • 6.38. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-fluorobiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00073
  • To 4′-bromo-2,2,2-trifluoroacetophenone (5.0 g, 19.76 mmol) in THF (50 mls) at 0° C. was added NaBH4 (1.5 g, 39.52 mmol). The mixture was warmed to room temperature and stirred for 1 hour. The reaction was complete by TLC(CH2Cl2). The mixture was quenched with H2O, rotary evaporated to remove most of the THF, and extracted 2 times with CH2Cl2. The organics were combined, washed with brine, concentrated to a small volume and filtered through a plug of silica gel. The silica was washed with CH2Cl2 to elute the product, and the resulting solution was concentrated to give 4.65 g of 1-(4-bromophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanol. Yield 92%.
  • To Pd(PPh3)4 (2.1 g, 1.823 mmol) was added 3-fluorophenylmagnesium bromide (55 mls, 1.0 M in THF, 55 mmol) at 0° C. over 15 minutes. The ice bath was removed and the mixture was stirred for 30 minutes. 1-(4-Bromophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanol (4.65 g, 18.23 mmol) in THF (50 mis) was added over 10 minutes. The mixture was heated to reflux for 3 hours and was shown complete by LC (Sunfire column, TFA). The mixture was cooled, quenched with H2O, rotary evaporated to remove most of the THF, and extracted 3 times with CH2Cl2. The organics were combined washed with brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated. Chromatography (SiO2, CH2Cl2) gave 4.64 g of 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-fluorobiphenyl-4-yl)ethanol. Yield 94%.
  • To 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-fluorobiphenyl-4-yl)ethanol (1.4 g, 5.18 mmol) in THF (50 mls) at 0° C. was added NaH (60% in mineral oil, 0.31 g, 7.77 mmol). The ice bath was removed and the mixture was stirred for 30 minutes. 2-Amino-4,6-dichloropyrimidine (1.0 g, 6.22 mmol) in THF (25 mls) was added at once. The mixture was heated to 50° C. for 5 hours. The reaction was complete by LCMS (Sunfire, TFA). The mixture was cooled, quenched with brine, and extracted 3 times with CH2Cl2. The organics were combined, washed with brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated. Chromatography (SiO2, CH2Cl2) afforded 1.48 g of 4-chloro-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-fluorobiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-2-amine. Yield 73%.
  • 4-Chloro-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-fluorobiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-2-amine (0.75 g, 1.89 mmol), L-p-boronophenylalanine (0.47 g, 2.26 mmol), Pd(PPh3)2Cl2 (79 mgs, 0.113 mmol), Na2CO3 (0.44 g, 4.15 mmol), acetonitrile (10 mls), and H2O (10 mls) were combined in a 20 ml microwave reactor and heated in the microwave at 150° C. for 7 minutes. The reaction was complete by LCMS (Sunfire, neutral). The mixture was concentrated, dissolved in NaOH (20 mls 0.5 N), filtered, extracted with ether three times, and cooled to 0° C. At 0° C., 1.0 N HCl was added slowly until a pH of 6.5 was attained. The mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 30 minutes and the product was filtered, dried in air, treated with excess 2.0 N HCl in ether, concentrated, then triturated with CH2Cl2 to give 1.12 g, 99% (95.5% purity). 385 mgs were purified via prep HPLC (Sunfire, TFA), concentrated, treated with excess 1.0 N HCl (aq.), concentrated to a small volume and lyophilized to afford 240 mgs of the captioned compound. M+1=527; 1H NMR 6 (CD3OD) 7.86 (d, 2H), 7.64 (s, 4H), 7.49 (d, 2H), 7.36 (m, 2H), 7.28 (m, 1H), 7.02 (m, 1H), 6.95 (s, 1H), 6.75 (q, 1H), 4.26 (t, 1H), 3.32 (m, 1H), 3.21 (m, 1H).
  • 6.39. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(benzylthio)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00074
  • Benzylmercaptan (0.14 g, 1.11 mmol) was treated with NaH (60% in mineral oil, 67 mg, 1.66 mmol) in dry THF (15 ml) for 30 minutes. 2-Amino-4,6-dichloropyrimidine (0.2 g, 1.22 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred overnight. The mixture was diluted with methylenechloride, washed with water, then brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated to give 0.11 g of 4-(benzylthio)-6-chloropyrimidin-2-amine.
  • 4-(Benzylthio)-6-chloropyrimidin-2-amine (0.1 g, 0.397 mmol), L-p-boronophenylalanine (0.1 g, 0.477 mmol), Pd(PPh3)2Cl2 (17 mg, 0.024 mmol), Na2CO3 (93 mg, 0.874 mmol), MeCN (2.5 ml) and water (2.5 ml) were heated at 150° C. for 5 minutes in a microwave. The mixture was concentrated and purified via prep HPLC to give 0.42 g of the title compound. M+1=381; 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 7.8 (d, 2H), 7.37 (t, 4H), 7.23 (m, 2H), 7.16 (m, 1H), 6.98 (s, 1H), 4.43 (s, 2H), 4.20 (t, 1H), 3.29 (m, 1H), 3.13 (M, 1H).
  • 6.40. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylthio)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00075
  • 2-Mercaptonapthalene (0.2 g, 1.148) was treated with NaH (60% in Mineral oil, 92 mg, 2.30 mmol) in dry THF (10 ml) for 30 minutes. 2-Amino-4,6-dichloropyrimidine (0.21 g, 1.26 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred overnight. The mixture was diluted with methylenechloride, washed with water, then brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated to give 0.18 g 4-chloro-6-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylthio)pyrimidin-2-amine.
  • 4-Chloro-6-(naphthalen-2-ylmethylthio)pyrimidin-2-amine (0.1 g, 0.331 mmol), L-p-boronophenylalanine (83 mg, 0.397 mmol), Pd(PPh3)2Cl2 (14 mg, 0.020 mmol), Na2CO3 (77 mg, 0.729 mmol), MeCN (2.5 ml) and water (2.5 ml) were heated at 150° C. for 5 minutes in a microwave. The mixture was concentrated and purified via prep HPLC to give 57 mg of the title compound. M+1=431; 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 7.85 (s, 1H), 7.79 (d, 2H), 7.72 (d, 3H), 7.46 (dd, 1H), 7.35 (m, 4H), 6.95 (s, 1H), 4.58 (s, 2H), 4.17 (m, 1H), 3.26 (m, 1H), 3.11 (m, 1H).
  • 6.41. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(3,4-difluorophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00076
  • 3,5-Difluorophenyl-trifluoromethyl ketone was treated with NaBH4 (0.18 g, 4.76 mmol) in THF (5 ml) for 2 hours. The mixture was quenched with water, extracted with methylene chloride (2×). The organics were combined, filtered through silica gel and concentrated to give 0.46 g of 1-(3,4-difluorophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanol.
  • 1-(3,4-Difluorophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanol (0.1 g, 0.471 mmol) was treated with NaH (60% in mineral oil, 38 mg, 0.943 mmol) in dry THF (3 ml) for 30 minutes. 2-Amino-4,6-dichloropyrimidine (77 mg, 0.471 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred at 50° C. for 6 hours. The mixture was quenched with water and extracted with methylenechloride (2×). The organics were combined, washed with water, then brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated to give 0.14 g of 4-chloro-6-(1-(3,4-difluorophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)-pyrimidin-2-amine.
  • 4-Chloro-6-(1-(3,4-difluorophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-2-amine (0.14 g, 0.421 mmol), L-p-boronophenylalanine (110 mg, 0.505 mmol), Pd(PPh3)2Cl2 (18 mg, 0.025 mmol), Na2CO3 (98 mg, 0.926 mmol), MeCN (2.5 ml) and water (2.5 ml) were heated at 150° C. for 5 minutes in a microwave. The mixture was concentrated and purified via prep HPLC to give 74 mg of the title compound. M+1=469; 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 7.83 (d, 2H), 7.47 (m, 1H), 7.38 (m, 4H), 7.28 (m, 1H), 4.21 (t, 1H), 3.29 (m, 1H), 3.15 (m, 1H).
  • 6.42. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00077
  • To 4′-bromo-2,2,2-trifluoroacetophenone (5.0 g, 19.76 mmol) in THF (50 mls) at 0° C. was added NaBH4 (1.5 g, 39.52 mmol). The mixture was warmed to room temperature and stirred for 1 hour. The reaction was complete by TLC(CH2Cl2). The mixture was quenched with H2O, rotary evaporated to remove most of the THF, and extracted 2 times with CH2Cl2. The organics were combined, washed with brine, concentrated to a small volume and filtered through a plug of silica gel. The silica was washed with CH2Cl2 to elute the product, and the resulting solution was concentrated to give 4.65 g of 1-(4-bromophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanol. Yield: 92%. 1-(4-Bromophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanol (0.13 g, 0.525 mmol), m-tolylboronic acid (0.1 g, 0.736 mmol), Fibercat (4.28% Pd, 47 mgs, 0.0157 mmol Pd), K2CO3 (0.22 g, 1.576 mmol), EtOH (3 mls), and H2O (0.5 mls) were combined and heated at 80° C. for 4 hours. The reaction was shown complete by TLC(CH2Cl2). The mixture was cooled, filtered, concentrated, slurried in CH2Cl2, and chromatographed over silica gel (CH2Cl2) to give 0.1 g of 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethanol. Yield: 72%.
  • Alternatively, 1-(4-bromophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanol (0.98 g, 3.86 mmol), m-tolylboronic acid (0.63 g, 4.63 mmol), Pd(PPh3)2Cl2 (0.16 g, 0.232 mmol Pd), Na2CO3 (0.90 g, 8.49 mmol), AcCN (10 mls), and H2O (10 mls) were combined and heated in the microwave at 150° C. for 10 minutes. The reaction was shown complete by TLC(CH2Cl2). The mixture was cooled, concentrated, slurried in CH2Cl2, filtered, and chromatographed over silica gel (CH2Cl2) to give 0.80 g of 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethanol. Yield: 79%.
  • Alternatively, tetrabutylammoniumfluoride (TBAF 1.0 N in THF 13 uL, 3.3 mg, 0.013 mmol) was added to a mixture of 3-methyl-biphenyl-2-carboxaldehyde (0.25 g, 1.27 mmol) and trifluoromethylrimethyl silane (0.25 g, 1.53 mmol), in THF (1.5 ml) at 0° C. The reaction was warmed to room temperature and stirred for 4 hours. HCl (3.0 N, 2.0 ml) was added, and the mixture was stirred for 3 hours. The mixture was concentrated, dissolved in methylene chloride, filtered through silica gel, and concentrated to give 0.15 g of 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethanol.
  • 2,2,2-Trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethanol (0.15 g, 0.563 mmol) was treated with NaH (60% in mineral oil, 45 mg, 1.12 mmol) in dry THF (5 ml) for 30 minutes. 2-Amino-4,6-dichloropyrimidine (92 mg, 0.5633 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred at 50° C. for 6 hours. The mixture was quenched with water and extracted with methylenechloride (2×). The organics were combined, washed with water, then brine, dried over MgSO4, and concentrated to give 0.16 g of 4-chloro-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-2-amine.
  • 4-Chloro-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-2-amine (0.16 g, 0.406 mmol), L-p-boronophenylalanine (10 mg, 0.487 mmol), Pd(PPh3)2Cl2 (17 mg, 0.024 mmol), Na2CO3 (95 mg, 0.894 mmol), MeCN (2.5 ml) and water (2.5 ml) were heated at 150° C. for 5 minutes in a microwave. The mixture was concentrated and purified via prep HPLC to give 105 mg of the title compound. M+1=523; 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 7.85 (d, 2H), 7.70 (d, 1H), 7.44 (m, 4H), 7.31 (t, 1H), 7.21 (m, 2H), 7.10 (m, 2H), 6.87 (q, 1H), 6.84 (s, 1H), 4.25 (t, 1H), 3.30 (m, 1H), 3.18 (m, 1H).
  • 6.43. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-(3-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methoxybenzylamino)pyridin-3-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00078
  • Sodium triacetoxyl-borohydride (245 mg, 1.16 mmol) was added to the solution of 5-bromo-pyridine-3-amine (100 mg, 0.57 mmol) and 3-cyclopentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzaldehyde (127 mg, 0.57 mmol) in 10 ml of 1,2-dichloroethtane (DCE), of HOAc (66 μL, 2 eq. 1.16 mmol) was added, the mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature, followed by addition of 15 ml of DCE. The organic phase was washed with water, and dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed by under reduced pressure to give 200 mg of crude 5-bromo-N-(3-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methoxybenzyl) pyridin-3-amine, which was used for the next step without further purification.
  • An Emrys process vial (2-5 ml) for microwave was charged with 5-bromo-N-(3-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methoxybenzyl)pyridin-3-amine (40 mg, 0.106 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (22 mg, 0.106 mmol) and 2 ml of acetonitrile. Aqueous sodium carbonate (2 ml, 1M) was added to above solution followed by 10 mol percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium (11). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 180° C. for 10 minutes with a microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 2.5 ml of methanol and purified with Prep-LC to give 20 mg of (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-3-(cyclophentyloxy-4-methoxy-benzylamino)pyridine-3-yl)phenyl)-propanoic acid. NMR: 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 1.59 (m, 2H), 1.7 (m, 6H), 3.17 (m, 1H), 3.3 (m, 1H), 3.75 (s, 3H), 4.2 (dd, 1H) 4.39 (s, 2H), 4.7 (m, 1H), 6.9 (m, 3H), 7.4 (d, 2H), 7.6 (d, 2H), 7.7 (s, 1H), 7.9 (s, 1H), 8.15 (s, 1H); Analytical HPLC: RT 2.69; M+1: 462 (RT: 1.285).
  • 6.44. Synthesis of 2-Amino-3-(3-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00079
  • To a solution of tert-butyl 2-(diphenylmethylene-amino) acetate (400 mg, 1.35 mmol) in THF (25 ml) was added a solution of LDA (1.8M in THF, 2 eq, 2.7 mmol, fresh bottle from Aldrich) over 5 minutes at −78° C., and the resulting mixture was stirred for 20 minutes. A solution of 2-(3-(bromomethyl) phenyl)-5,5-dimethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborinane (460 mg, 1.2 eq. 1.62 mmol) in THF (10 ml) was added drop-wise to the reaction mixture over 5 minutes. The reaction was continued at same (−78° C.) temperature for 30 minutes, and left for 3 hours at room temperature. The reaction was quenched with saturated NH4Cl, followed by the addition of water (30 ml), and was extracted with EtOAc (2×40 ml). The organic fractions were combined and dried over Na2SO4. The solvent was then concentrated at reduced pressure and crude tert-Butyl-3-(3-(5,5-dimethyl-1, 3, 2-dioxaborinan-2-yl)phenyl) 2-(diphenylmethylene amino) propionate was purified by column chromatography to provide the product as a semi-solid.
  • An Emrys process vial (20 ml) for microwave was charged with (R)-6-chloro-N2-(1-(naphthalene-2-yl)ethyl)-1,3,5-triazine-2,4-diamine (100 mg, 0.33 mmol), tert-butyl-3-(3-(5,5-dimethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborinan-2-yl)phenyl)-2-(diphenyl methyleneamino) propanoate (248 mg, 0.5 mmol, 1.5 eq.) and 6 ml of acetonitrile plus 6 ml of aqueous sodium carbonate (1M) was added to above solution followed by 10 mol percent of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 190° C. for 10 minutes with microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 10 ml of THF, to which was added 5N.HCl (5 ml). The mixture was refluxed for 2 hours in order to deprotect the benzophone and tert-butyl groups. The resulting reaction mixture was concentrated and dissolved in methanol (8 ml) and purified with Prep-LC to afford 15 mg of 2-amino-3-(4(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalene-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-trizin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid. NMR: 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 1.85 (d, 3H), 3.2-3.45 (m, 2H), 4.37 (m, 1H), 5.5 (m, 1H), 7.4 (m, 1H), 7.6 (m 4H), 7.9 (m, 4H), 8.18 (m, 2H), Analytical HPLC: RT 2.79 M+1: 429 (RT: 1.35).
  • 6.45. Synthesis of 2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)-2-fluorophenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00080
  • To a solution of tert-butyl 2-(diphenylmethylene-amino) acetate (1.1 g, 3.73 mmol) in THF (30 ml) was added a solution of LDA (1.8M in THF, 1 eq, 3.73 mmol, fresh bottle from Aldrich) over 5 minutes at −78° C., and the resulting mixture was stirred for 20 minutes. A solution of 4-bromo-1-(bromomethyl)-2-fluorobenezene (1 g, 3.74 mmol) in THF (10 ml) was added drop-wise to the reaction mixture over 5 minutes. The reaction was continued at −78° C. for 30 minutes, after which it was left at room temperature for 3 hours. The reaction was quenched with saturated NH4Cl, after which water (30 ml) was added. Product was extracted with EtOAc (2×40 ml), and the organic fractions were combined and dried over Na2SO4. The solvent was concentrated at reduced pressure and crude tert-Butyl 3-(4-bromo-2-fluorophenyl)-2-(diphenylmethyleneamino)-propanoate was purified by column chromatography. The product was obtained as a solid.
  • An Emrys process vial (20 ml) for microwave was charged with tert-butyl 3-(4-bromo-2-fluorophenyl)-2-(diphenylmethylene-amino)propanoate (600 mg, 1.24 mmol), Pd(dba)2 (71 mg, 0.124 mmol), PCy3 (35 mg, 0.124 mmol), 4,4,4′,4′,5,5,5′,5′-octamethyl-2,2′-bi(1,3,2-dioxaborolane (346 mg, 1.1 eq. 1.36 mmol) and KOAc (182 mg, 1.5 eq., 1.86 mmol) 20 ml of DMF. The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 160° C. for 20 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in H2O (30 ml), extracted with EtOAc (2×40 ml), and purified with Prep-LC to give 220 mg of tert-butyl 2-(diphenylmethyleneamino)-3-(2-fluoro-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)phenyl)propanoate.
  • An Emrys process vial (5 ml) for microwave was charged with (R)-6-chloro-N2-(1-(naphthalene-2-yl)ethyl)-1,3,5-triazine-2,4-diamine (67 mg, 0.22 mmol), tert-butyl-2-(diphenylmethyleneamino)-3-(2-fluoro-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)phenyl)propanoate (120 mg, 0.22 mmol) and 2 ml of acetonitrile. Aqueous sodium carbonate (2 ml, 1M) was added to above solution followed by 10 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 190° C. for 10 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 10 ml of THF, to which 5N.HCl (2 ml) was then added. The mixture was refluxed for 2 hours (deprotection of benzophone and tert-butyl groups). After deprotection of two groups, the mixture was concentrated, dissolved in methanol (5 ml), and purified with Prep-LC to afford 10 mg of 2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalene-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-trizin-2-yl)-2-fluorophenyl)propanoic acid. NMR: 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 1.6 (d, 3H), 3.07 (m, 1H), 3.45 (m, 1H), 3.8 (m, 1H), 5.45 (m, 1H), 7.4 (m, 4H), 7.6 (m 1H), 7.8 (m, 4H), 8.08 (m, 1H), Analytical HPLC: RT 2.88, M+1: 447 (RT: 1.44).
  • 6.46. Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(1-(adamantyll)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00081
  • A solution of adamantine amine (1 equivalent), 2-amino-4,6-dichloro-[1,3,5]triazine (1 equivalent) and diisopropyl ethyl amine (5 equivalents, Aldrich) in anhydrous 1,4-dioxane was refluxed at 130° C. for 3 hours. After completion of the reaction, the dioxane was removed under reduced pressure. The reaction was then cooled to room temperature, water was added, and product was extracted with dichloromethane (2×40 ml). The combined organic solution was dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated to afford product, which was used in the next step without purification.
  • An Emrys process vial (20 ml) for microwave was charged with adamantine trizine chloride (200 mg, 0.65 mmol), 4-borono-L-phenylalanine (135 mg, 0.65 mmol) and 5 ml of acetonitrile. Aqueous sodium carbonate (5 ml, 1M) was added to above solution followed by 5 mol percent dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II). The reaction vessel was sealed and heated to 190° C. for 20 minutes by microwave. After cooling, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness. The residue was dissolved in 4 ml of methanol and purified with Prep-LC to give 60 mg (yield 21%) of coupled product. NMR: 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 1.22 (m, 3H), 1.6-1-8 (m, 12H), 2.01 (d, 3H), 3.25-3.42 (m, 2H), 4.0 (m, 1H), 4.40 (m, 1H), 7.6 (d, 2H), 8.2 (d, 2H), Analytical HPLC: RT 3.11, M+1: 437 (RT: 1.76).
  • 6.47. Alternative Synthesis of (2S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(1-(adamantyll)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Adamantane (2-yl)ethyl cyanoguanidine was prepared by forming a solution of cyanoguanidine (1 equivalent), (S)-2-amino-3-(4-cyanophenylpropanoic acid (1 equivalent) and potassium tertiary butaoxide (3.5 equivalent, Aldrich) in dry n-BuOH, which was vigorously refluxed at 160° C. in a sealed tube for 2 days. After completion of the reaction, the mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature, and the reaction was quenched with water. Solvent was removed under reduced pressure. Again, after allowing to cool to room temperature, the reaction mixture was brought to pH 12-14 by adding 1N NaOH. Then, impurities were removed while extracting with Ether:EtOAc (9:1, 2×100 ml). The aqueous solution was cooled to 0° C., 1N HCl was then added to adjust pH to 7. The pale yellow product was slowly crashed out in H2O, the mixture was kept in a refrigerator for 30 minutes, and the solid was obtained by filtration with 92% purity. Compound was crystallized from MeOH to afford a white solid (>98% pure, 48-78% yield). 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 1.0 (d, 3H), 1.45-1.6 (m, 6H), 4.62-4.8 (m, 4H) 2.0 (m, 2H), 3.3 (m, 1H), 3.5 (m, 1H); Analytical HPLC: RT 2.69; M+1: 462 (RT: 1.285).
  • The title compound was prepared from adamantane (2-yl)ethyl cyanoguanidine using the method shown in Scheme 6.
  • 6.48. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-fluoro-4-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)pyrimidin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00082
  • A mixture of (R)-(+)-1-(2-napthyl)ethylamine (102.6 mg, 0.599 mmol), 2,4-dichloro-5-fluoro pyrimidine (100 mg, 0.599 mmol) and cesium carbonate (390 mg, 1.2 mmol) was dissolved in 1,4-dioxane (3 ml) and H2O (3 ml) in a 10 ml microwave vial. The mixture was stirred in the microwave reactor at 80° C. for 10 minutes. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (50 ml), washed with water (20 ml), brine (20 ml) dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to get the crude intermediate 2-chloro-5-fluoro-pyrimidin-4-yl)-(1-naphthalen-2-yl-ethyl)-amine.
  • The crude intermediate (250 mg, 0.83 mmol) was then dissolved in 6.0 ml of MeCN and 6 ml of H2O in a 20 ml microwave vial. To this solution were added L-p-borono-phenylalanine (173.6 mg, 0.83 mmol), sodium carbonate (173.6 mg, 1.66 mmol) and catalytic amount of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (11.6 mg, 0.0166 mmol). The reaction vial was then sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 7 minutes. The contents were then filtered, and the filtrate was concentrated and dissolved in MeOH and H2O (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H2O/TFA as the solvent system. The combined pure fraction were evaporated in vacuo and further dried on a lyophilizer to give 154 mg of 2-amino-3-{4-[5-fluoro-4-(1-naphthalen-2-yl-ethylamino)-pyrimidin-2-yl]-phenyl}-propionic acid. NMR: 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD) δ 1.8 (d, 3H) 3.2-3.4 (m, 2H), 4.35 (m, 1H), 5.7 (q, 1H), 7.5 (m, 4H), 7.6 (d, 1H), 7.8-7.9 (m, 4H), 8.1 (d, 2H), 8.3 (d, 1H). LCMS: M+1=431.
  • 6.49. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(4-(trifluoromethyl)-benzylamino)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00083
  • A mixture of trifluoromethyl benzylamine (106.8 mg, 0.610 mmol), 2-amino-4,6-dichloropyrimidine (100 mg, 0.610 mmol) and cesium carbonate (217 mg, 1.2 mmol) was dissolved in 1,4-dioxane (6 ml) and H2O (6 ml) in a 20 ml microwave vial. The mixture was stirred in the microwave reactor at 210° C. for 25 minutes. The solvent was then removed. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (50 ml), washed with water (20 ml), brine (20 ml), dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to get the crude intermediate 6-chloro-N-4′-(trifluoromethyl-benzyl)-pyrimidine-2-4-diamine.
  • The crude intermediate (150 mg, 0.497 mmol) was then dissolved in 3.0 ml of MeCN and 3 ml of H2O in a 10 ml microwave vial. To this solution were added L-p-borono-phenylalanine (104 mg, 0.497 mmol), sodium carbonate (150 mg, 0.994 mmol) and catalytic amount of dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (6.9 mg, 0.00994 mmol). The reaction vial was then sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 5 minutes. The contents were filtered, and the filtrate was concentrated and dissolved in MeOH and H2O (1:1) and purified by preparative HPLC using a MeOH/H2O/TFA solvent system. The combined pure fractions were evaporated in vacuo and further dried on a lyophilizer to afford 2-amino-3-{4-[2-amino-6-(4-trifluoromethyl-benzylamino)-pyrimidin-4-yl]-phenyl}-propionic acid. NMR: 1H-NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD) δ 3.1-3.3 (m, 2H), 4.2 (t, 1H), 4.7 (s, 2H), 6.3 (s, 1H), 7.4-7.5 (m, 4H), 7.6 (d, 2H), 7.7 (d, 2H). LCMS: M+1=432.
  • 6.50. Synthesis of 2-Amino-3-(5-(5-phenylthiophen-2-yl)-1H-indol-3-yl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00084
  • 2-Amino-3-(5-bromo-1H-indol-3-yl)-propionic acid (0.020 g, 0.071 mmol) was added to a 5 ml microwave vial, which contained 5-phenyl-thiophen-2-boronic acid (0.016 g, 0.078 mmol), Na2CO3 (0.015 g, 0.142 mmol), acetonitrile (1.5 ml)/water (1.5 ml) and dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium (3 mg, 0.003 mmol). Microwave vial was capped and stirred at 150° C. for 5 min under microwave radiation. Reaction mixture was cooled, filtered through a syringe filter and then separated by a reverse phase preparative-HPLC using YMC-Pack ODS 100×30 mm ID column (MeOH/H2O/TFA solvent system). The pure fractions were concentrated in vacuum. The product was then suspended in 5 ml of water, frozen and lyophilized to give 5 mg of pure product, 2-amino-3-[5-(5-phenyl-thiophen-2-yl)-1H-indol-3-yl]-propionic acid. 1H-NMR (300 MHz, CD3OD): 3.21-3.26 (m, 2H), 4.25 (q, 1H), 7.15-7.35 (m, 8H), 7.58 (d, 2H), 7.82 (d, 1H).
  • 6.51. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-(4-phenoxyphenyl)-1H-1,2,3-triazol-1-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00085
  • A mixture of 1-ethynyl-4-phenoxy-benzene (126 mg, 0.65 mmol) and (S)-3-(4-azido-phenyl)-2-tert-butoxycarbonylamino-propionic acid (200 mg, 0.65 mg) in H2O:dioxane (5:1) was heated at 100° C. in a sealed tube for overnight. After completion of reaction, 3N HCl (5 ml) was added and the mixture was stirred for 2 hr at 50° C. Removal of solvent gave crude product which was dissolved in MeOH and purified by preparative HPLC to give 45 mg of desired product (yield: 29%). 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ (ppm) 3.2 (m, 1H), 3.4 (m, 1H), 4.3 (m, 1H), 6.9 (d, 2H), 7.0 (d, 2H), 7.2 (m, 1H), 7.3 (d, 2H), 7.4-7.55 (m, 6H), 8.0 (s, 1H).
  • 6.52. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(4-(4-(thiophene-2-carboxamido)phenyl)-1H-1,2,3-triazol-1-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid and (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(5-(4-(thiophene-2-carboxamido)phenyl)-1H-1,2,3-triazol-1-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00086
  • A mixture of thiophene-2-carboxylic acid (4-ethyl-phenyl) amide (117 mg, 0.49 mmol) and (S)-3-(4-azido-phenyl)-2-tert-butoxycarbonylamino-propionic acid (150 mg, 0.49 mg) in 5 ml of H2O:dioxane (5:1) was heated at 100° C. in a sealed tube overnight. After completion of reaction, 3N HCl (5 ml) was added and the mixture was stirred for 2 hr at 50° C. Removal of solvent gave crude product which was dissolved in MeOH and purified by preparative HPLC. According to LCMS (retention time) and NMR, two regio-isomers were obtained (total yield: 70 mg, 66%). The major product is (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-(4-(thiophene-2-carboxamido)phenyl)-1H-1,2,3-triazol-1-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid. NMR: 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 3.2 (m, 1H), 3.4 (m, 1H), 4.3 (m, 1H), 7.15 (m, 1H), 7.3 (d, 2H), 7.6 (m, 4H), 7.0 (m, 3H), 7.95 (d, 1H), 8.0 (s, 1H). The minor product is (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(4-(thiophene-2-carboxamido)phenyl)-1H-1,2,3-triazol-1-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid. 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ 3.2 (m, 1H), 3.4 (m, 1H), 4.35 (m, 1H), 7.2 (m, 1H), 7.3 (d, 2H), 7.5-7.6 (m, 4H), 7.75 (m, 3H), 7.95 (d, 1H), 8.05 (s, 1H).
  • 6.53. Synthesis of (S)-2-Amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(phenylethynyl)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00087
  • 2-Amino 4,6-dichloro pyrimidine (0.180 g, 1.1 mmol), trimethyl-phenylethynyl-stannane (0.264 g, 1 mmol), were dissolved in THF (20 ml) and the mixture was stirred at 65° C. for 12 h. LCMS indicated the completion of reaction. Solvent was removed and the residue was directly used in the following step.
  • The crude intermediate (0.42 g), L-p-borono-phenylalanine (0.210 g, 1 mmol), sodium carbonate (0.210 g, 2 mmol), and dichlorobis(triphenylphosphine)-palladium(II) (25 mg, 0.036 mmol) were dissolved in a mixture of MeCN (3 ml) and H2O (3 ml) in a 10 ml microwave vial. The vial was sealed and stirred in the microwave reactor at 150° C. for 6 min. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated. Residue was purified by preparative HPLC using MeOH/H2O/TFA as solvent system to obtain (S)-2-amino-3-[4-(2-amino-6-phenylethynyl-pyrimidin-4-yl(-phenyl]-propionic acid as a TFA salt. 1H-NMR (400 MHz, CD3OD): δ (ppm) 3.20-3.42 (m, 2H), 4.31 (m, 1H), 7.40-7.51 (m, 6H), 7.62 (d, 2H), 8.18 (d, 2H).
  • 6.54. Additional Compounds
  • Additional compounds prepared using methods known in the art and/or described herein are listed below:
  • LCMS HPLC Method
    Compound (M + 1) (Time (min))
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(2-fluoro-4,5-dimethoxybenzylamino)pyrazin-2- 426 C (3.04)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(4-(2-methoxyphenyl)piperidin-1- 448 I (3.03)
    yl)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(3-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methoxybenzylamino)-2- 507 J (3.21)
    (dimethylamino)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(3,4-dimethylbenzylamino)pyrazin-2- 377 C (3.15)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(biphenyl-2-ylmethylamino)pyrazin-2- 425 D (4.00)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-ethyl 2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(4- 460 F (2.52)
    (trifluoromethyl)benzylamino)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoate
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(cyclopentylmethylamino)pyrazin-2- 341 C (2.77)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(3-(2- 472 A (2.87)
    (trifluoromethyl)phenyl)pyrrolidin-1-yl)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphthalen-1- 404 A (2.65)
    ylamino)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2- 429 A (2.73)
    yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1,2-diphenylethylamino)pyrimidin-4- 454 K (1.34)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-1-(4-(benzo[b]thiophen-3- 510 D (2.02)
    yl)phenyl)ethylamino)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(4′-methoxybiphenyl-4- 485 J (2.99)
    yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    2-amino-3-(1-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5- 436 B (2.25)
    triazin-2-yl)piperidin-4-yl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(1-(4-fluoronaphthalen-1- 447 H (1.68)
    yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((3′-fluorobiphenyl-4-yl)methylamino)- 459 J (2.89)
    1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5- 447 A (2.88)
    triazin-2-yl)-2-fluorophenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′- 539 M (3.83)
    methoxybiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-fluorobiphenyl-2- 528 F (3.41)
    yl)ethoxy)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(1-(4-tert-butylphenyl)ethylamino)- 435 J (1.82)
    1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-fluorobiphenyl-4- 527 D (2.09)
    yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(6,7-dihydroxy-1-methyl-3,4- 437 B (2.47)
    dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl- 524 D (2.22)
    4-yl)ethoxy)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2- 428 A (2.90)
    yl)ethylamino)pyrimidin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(benzylthio)pyrimidin-4- 379 E (1.66)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4′-fluorobiphenyl-4- 527 E (2.07)
    yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(3-(4-chlorophenoxy)piperidin-1-yl)pyrimidin-4- 453 A (2.67)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-1,3,5- 486 J (2.83)
    triazin-2-yl)phenyl)-2-(2-aminoacetamido)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-((R)-1-(naphthalen-2-yl)ethylamino)-2- 481 A (3.70)
    (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(4-(3-chlorophenyl)piperazin-1- 453 L (0.72)
    yl)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1- 433 E (1.77)
    phenylethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1,4-diphenylbutylamino)pyrimidin-4- 482 A (3.15)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(1-(3′-chlorobiphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2- 528 E (2.35)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-(1-(biphenyl-4-yl)-2,2,2- 510 D (2.14)
    trifluoroethoxy)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,3,3,3-pentafluoro-1-(3-fluoro-4- 515 N (3.34)
    methylphenyl)propoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-ethyl 2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′- 567 N (2.17)
    methoxybiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoate
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((S)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′- 539 N (3.36)
    methoxybiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3-fluoro-3′- 557 O (3.52)
    methoxybiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(3′-(dimethylamino)biphenyl-2-yl)- 552 Q (3.00)
    2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methoxy-5- 553 N (3.63)
    methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4′-methoxy-5- 553 N (3.61)
    methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methoxy-3- 617 O (3.28)
    (methylsulfonyl)biphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(2-(cyclopropylmethoxy)-4- 521 N (1.57)
    fluorophenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(1-(2-(cyclopropylmethoxy)-4-fluorophenyl)- 507 N (1.62)
    2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2- 520 N (1.69)
    (isopentyloxy)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-fluorobiphenyl-4- 512
    yl)ethoxy)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4′-methoxybiphenyl- 539 N (3.50)
    2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(3′-carbamoylbiphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2- 552 N (3.14)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(4′-carbamoylbiphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2- 552 N (3.05)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-(2- 555 N (1.55)
    methoxyphenoxy)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-(2- 541 N (1.59)
    methoxyphenoxy)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2- 505 N (1.74)
    (isopentyloxy)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-3-(4-(6-(1-(3′-acetamidobiphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)-2- 566 N (3.18)
    aminopyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)-2-aminopropanoic acid
    (2S)-3-(4-(6-(1-(4′-acetamidobiphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)-2- 566 N (3.23)
    aminopyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)-2-aminopropanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(4-cyanophenyl)-2,2,2- 458
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-ethyl 2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-p- 475
    tolylethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoate
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(1- 493 O (2.97)
    methoxybicyclo[2.2.2]oct-5-en-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(4-(cyclopentyloxy)phenyl)-2,2,2- 517 N (1.61)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(1-(4-(cyclopentyloxy)phenyl)-2,2,2- 503 N (1.67)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-(3- 556 N (1.59)
    methoxyphenoxy)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(4,5-dimethoxybiphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2- 569 S (3.34)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(4,5-dimethoxy-3′-methylbiphenyl- 583 S (3.50)
    2-yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2′-methylbiphenyl-2- 508
    yl)ethoxy)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-(3- 541 N (1.64)
    methoxyphenoxy)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(2-(3,5-difluorophenoxy)phenyl)- 561 N (1.64)
    2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-(4- 556 N (1.58)
    methoxyphenoxy)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(4′-((S)-2-amino-2- 596
    carboxyethyl)biphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(2-bromophenyl)-2,2,2- 513
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methylbiphenyl-2- 508
    yl)ethoxy)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-methoxybiphenyl- 539 S (3.51)
    2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2-(4-methylthiophen-3- 514
    yl)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-methoxy-3′- 553 S (3.66)
    methylbiphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′- 539
    (hydroxymethyl)biphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(3′-cyanobiphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2- 534
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(1-(2-(3,5-difluorophenoxy)phenyl)-2,2,2- 547 N (1.69)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-(4- 541 N (1.63)
    methoxyphenoxy)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2-(4-methylthiazol- 536
    2-yl)thiophen-3-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(5-(4- 530 O (3.14)
    methoxyphenyl)isoxazol-3-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(1-phenyl-5- 567 O (3.24)
    (trifluoromethyl)-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(2-(cyclohexyloxy)-4-methylphenyl)- 545 N (1.76)
    2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(2-(cyclopentyloxy)-4- 532 N (1.71)
    methylphenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(benzo[d]thiazol-6-yl)-2,2,2- 490 O (2.66)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(1-methyl-1H- 437
    imidazol-5-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(1-(2-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-methylphenyl)-2,2,2- 517 N (1.78)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(1-(2-(cyclohexyloxy)-4-methylphenyl)-2,2,2- 531 N (1.87)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(pyridin-3- 434
    yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(1,3-dimethyl-1H-pyrazol-5-yl)- 451
    2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(3-hydroxyphenyl)pyrimidin-4- 351
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-hydroxybiphenyl- 526
    2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(3,5-difluorophenyl)pyrimidin-4- 371
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(3′,5′-difluorobiphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2- 546
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-fluorobiphenyl-3- 512
    yl)ethoxy)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(5-ethoxy-2-methyl-2,3- 533 O (3.16)
    dihydrobenzofuran-6-yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(benzofuran-5-yl)-2,2,2- 473
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2-m-tolylfuran-3- 513
    yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-ethyl 3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methoxybiphenyl- 596 N (3.55)
    4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)-2-(2-aminoacetamido)propanoate
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2-(4-methylthiophen-3- 514
    yl)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(5-methyl-3- 514 N (3.12)
    phenylisoxazol-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(3-(methylthio)phenyl)pyrimidin-4- 381
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′- 555
    (methylthio)biphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(3′- 566
    ((dimethylamino)methyl)biphenyl-2-yl)-2,2,2-
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(3-(trifluoromethoxy)phenyl)pyrimidin- 419
    4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′- 593
    (trifluoromethoxy)biphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methoxybiphenyl-4- 596 N (1.51)
    yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)-2-(2-aminoacetamido)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(1-methyl-5-phenyl- 513 N (2.88)
    1H-pyrazol-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4- 511
    (methylsulfonyl)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-1-(3′-(dimethylamino)biphenyl-2- 552 S (3.09)
    yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(2-chloro-4- 545
    (methylsulfonyl)phenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3-(furan-2- 505
    yl)thiophen-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(2-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-fluorophenyl)- 543 N (1.66)
    2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2-(3- 543 O (3.59)
    methoxyphenyl)cyclohex-1-enyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(pyrimidin-5- 435
    yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methoxybiphenyl-3- 524
    yl)ethoxy)pyrazin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((S)-1-(3′-(dimethylamino)biphenyl-2- 552 N (3.08)
    yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(2-(furan-2- 542 N (2.61)
    carboxamido)phenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(4-chloro-2- 545
    (methylsulfonyl)phenyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-isopropyl 2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′- 581
    methoxybiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoate
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(1-(2-(cyclopentyloxy)-4-fluorophenyl)-2,2,2- 520 N (1.73)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(1-(2-(cyclohexyloxy)-4-fluorophenyl)-2,2,2- 534 N (1.81)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(1-(thiophen-2- 521 O (3.36)
    yl)cyclohexyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methoxybiphenyl-4- 529 Q (2.30)
    yl)ethoxy)thiazol-5-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(2-(cyclohexyloxy)-4-fluorophenyl)- 549 N (1.70)
    2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(1-(4- 545 O (3.41)
    methoxyphenyl)cyclohexyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-fluoro-2- 450 N (1.50)
    methylphenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4-fluoro-2- 465 N (1.45)
    methylphenyl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(oxazol-2- 432 O (1.76)
    yl(phenyl)methoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-cyclohexyl-2,2,2- 452 O (3.47)
    trifluoroethylideneaminooxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(2-(3-(dimethylamino)phenyl)furan- 543 N (3.02)
    3-yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(5-phenylthiophen- 515 N (3.39)
    2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-phenyl 2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′- 615 Q (3.00)
    methoxybiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoate
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-1-(3′- 566 N (2.60)
    ((dimethylamino)methyl)biphenyl-4-yl)-2,2,2-
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(1-(3-methoxybenzoyl)-1H-pyrazol-4- 366 O (2.55)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(5-phenylfuran-2- 484 N (3.65)
    yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(4-chloro-2-fluorophenyl)-2,2,2- 486 N (3.14)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S,E)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(4-(trifluoromethyl)styryl)pyrimidin-4- 429 N (2.94)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-2,2,2- 502 N (3.31)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-(4-chloro-3-fluorophenyl)-2,2,2- 486 N (3.13)
    trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-1-(3′-(dimethylamino)biphenyl-4- 552 N (2.66)
    yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1-chloro-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(4- 573 N (3.77)
    methoxybiphenyl-2-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(5-phenylthiophen-2- 500 N (3.75)
    yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(5-(4-phenoxyphenyl)-1H-1,2,3-triazol-1- 401 O (3.20)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S,E)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2-(biphenyl-4-yl)vinyl)pyrimidin-4- 437 N (3.17)
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′- 539
    methoxybiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-2-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(4′-methoxybiphenyl-4- 428 N (2.78)
    ylsulfonamido)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(6-(3- 540 N (3.09)
    methoxyphenyl)pyridin-3-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(6-(2-fluoro-3- 558 N (3.00)
    methoxyphenyl)pyridin-3-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    2-amino-3-(5-(4′-methylbiphenyl-4-yl)-1H-indol-3-yl)propanoic acid 371 N (1.48)
    2-amino-3-(5-m-tolyl-1H-indol-3-yl)propanoic acid 295 N (1.19)
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-(2-methoxyphenyl)furan-3- 358 O (2.68)
    carboxamido)phenyl)propanoic acid
    2-amino-3-(5-(1-benzyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-1H-indol-3-yl)propanoic acid 361 N (1.10)
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(6-(thiophen-2- 516 N (1.42)
    yl)pyridin-3-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    2-amino-3-(6-(1-benzyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)-1H-indol-3-yl)propanoic acid 361 N (1.09)
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-((2-(4-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl)thiazol-4- 422 O (3.00)
    yl)methylamino)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-((4′-methoxybiphenyl-4- 441 O (2.94)
    ylsulfonamido)methyl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(3-(2-methoxydibenzo[b,d]furan-3- 420 O (3.36)
    yl)ureido)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(3-(2,2-diphenylethyl)ureido)phenyl)propanoic acid 404 O (2.97)
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(phenylethynyl)phenyl)propanoic acid 266 N (2.91)
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((5-(1-methyl-5-(trifluoromethyl)-1H- 410 N (1.39)
    pyrazol-3-yl)thiophen-2-yl)methoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic
    acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(1,1,1-trifluoro-3-((R)-2,2,3- 479 O (3.42)
    trimethylcyclopent-3-enyl)propan-2-yloxy)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(3-(2- 429 N (1.53)
    hydroxyethylcarbamoyl)piperidin-1-yl)pyrimidin-4-
    yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (2S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(3-(pyridin-2-yloxy)piperidin-1- 435 N (2.11)
    yl)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
    (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-(4-chloro-3-(piperidine-1- 480 N (2.75)
    carbonyl)phenyl)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid
  • 6.55. In Vitro Inhibition Assays
  • Human TPH1, TPH2, tyrosine hydroxylase (TH) and phenylalanine hydroxylase (PH) were all generated using genes having the following accession numbers, respectively: X52836, AY098914, X05290, and U49897.
  • The full-length coding sequence of human TPH1 was cloned into the bacterial expression vector pET24 (Novagen, Madison, Wis., USA). A single colony of BL21(DE3) cells harboring the expression vector was inoculated into 50 ml of L broth (LB)-kanamycin media and grown up at 37° C. overnight with shaking. Half of the culture (25 ml) was then transferred into 3 L of media containing 1.5% yeast extract, 2% Bacto Peptone, 0.1 mM tryptophan, 0.1 mM ferrous ammonium sulfate, and 50 mM phosphate buffer (pH 7.0), and grown to OD600=6 at 37° C. with oxygen supplemented at 40%, pH maintained at 7.0, and glucose added. Expression of TPH1 was induced with 15% D-lactose over a period of 10 hours at 25° C. The cells were spun down and washed once with phosphate buffered saline (PBS).
  • TPH1 was purified by affinity chromatography based on its binding to pterin. The cell pellet was resuspended in a lysis buffer (100 ml/20 g) containing 50 mM Tris-Cl, pH 7.6, 0.5 M NaCl, 0.1% Tween-20, 2 mM EDTA, 5 mM DTT, protease inhibitor mixture (Roche Applied Science, Indianapolis, Ind., USA) and 1 mM phenylmethanesulfonyl fluoride (PMSF), and the cells were lyzed with a microfluidizer. The lysate was centrifuged and the supernatant was loaded onto a pterin-coupled sepharose 4B column that was equilibrated with a buffer containing 50 mM Tris, pH 8.0, 2 M NaCl, 0.1% Tween-20, 0.5 mM EDTA, and 2 mM DTT. The column was washed with 50 ml of this buffer and TPH1 was eluded with a buffer containing 30 mM NaHCO3, pH 10.5, 0.5 M NaCl, 0.1% Tween-20, 0.5 mM EDTA, 2 mM DTT, and 10% glycerol. Eluted enzyme was immediately neutralized with 200 mM KH2PO4, pH 7.0, 0.5 M NaCl, 20 mM DTT, 0.5 mM EDTA, and 10% glycerol, and stored at −80° C.
  • Human tryptophan hydroxylase type II (TPH2), tyrosine hydroxylase (TH) and phenylalanine hydroxylase (PAH) were expressed and purified essentially in the same way, except the cells were supplemented with tyrosine for TH and phenylalanine for PAH during growth.
  • TPH1 and TPH2 activities were measured in a reaction mixture containing 50 mM 4-morpholinepropanesulfonic acid (MOPS), pH 7.0, 60 μM tryptophan, 100 mM ammonium sulfate, 100 μM ferrous ammonium sulfate, 0.5 mM tris(2-carboxyethyl)phosphine (TCEP), 0.3 mM 6-methyl tetrahydropterin, 0.05 mg/ml catalase, and 0.9 mM DTT. The reactions were initiated by adding TPH1 to a final concentration of 7.5 nM. Initial velocity of the reactions was determined by following the change of fluorescence at 360 nm (excitation wavelength=300 nm). TPH1 and TPH2 inhibition was determined by measuring their activities at various compound concentrations, and the potency of a given compound was calculated using the equation:
  • v = b + v 0 - b 1 + ( [ C ] [ I c 50 ] ) D
  • where v is the initial velocity at a given compound concentration C, v0 is the v when C=0, b is the background signal, D is the Hill slope which is approximately equal to 1, and Ic50 is the concentration of the compound that inhibits half of the maximum enzyme activity.
  • Human TH and PAH activities were determined by measuring the amount of 3H2O generated using L-[3,4-3H]-tyrosine and L-[4-3H]-phenylalanine, respectively. The enzyme (100 nM) was first incubated with its substrate at 0.1 mM for about 10 minutes, and added to a reaction mixture containing 50 mM MOPS, pH 7.2, 100 mM ammonium sulfate, 0.05% Tween-20, 1.5 mM TCEP, 100 μM ferrous ammonium sulfate, 0.1 mM tyrosine or phenylalanine, 0.2 mM 6-methyl tetrahydropterin, 0.05 mg/ml of catalase, and 2 mM DTT. The reactions were allowed to proceed for 10-15 minutes and stopped by the addition of 2 M HCl. The mixtures were then filtered through activated charcoal and the radioactivity in the filtrate was determined by scintillation counting. Activities of compounds on TH and PAH were determined using this assay and calculated in the same way as on TPH1 and TPH2.
  • 6.56. Cell-Based Inhibition Assays
  • Two types of cell lines were used for screening: RBL2H3 is a rat mastocytoma cell line, which contains TPH1 and makes 5-hydroxytrypotamine (5HT) spontaneously; BON is a human carcinoid cell line, which contains TPH1 and makes 5-hydroxytryptophan (5HTP). The CBAs were performed in 96-well plate format. The mobile phase used in HPLC contained 97% of 100 mM sodium acetate, pH 3.5 and 3% acetonitrile. A Waters C18 column (4.6×50 mm) was used with Waters HPLC (model 2795). A multi-channel fluorometer (model 2475) was used to monitor the flow through by setting at 280 nm as the excitation wavelength and 360 nm as the emission wavelength.
  • RBL CBA:
  • Cells were grown in complete media (containing 5% bovine serum) for 3-4 hours to allow cells to attach to plate wells (7K cell/well). Compounds were then added to each well in the concentration range of 0.016 μM to 11.36 μM. The controls were cells in complete media without any compound present. Cells were harvested after 3 days of incubation at 37° C. Cells were >95% confluent without compound present. Media were removed from plate and cells were lysed with equal volume of 0.1N NaOH. A large portion of the cell lysate was treated by mixing with equal volume of 1M TCA and then filtered through glass fiber. The filtrates were loaded on reverse phase HPLC for analyzing 5HT concentrations. A small portion of the cell lysate was also taken to measure protein concentration of the cells that reflects the cytotoxicity of the compounds at the concentration used. The protein concentration was measured by using BCA method.
  • The average of 5HT level in cells without compound treated was used as the maximum value in the IC50 derivation according to the equation provided above. The minimum value of 5HT is either set at 0 or from cells that treated with the highest concentration of compound If a compound is not cytotoxic at that concentration.
  • BON CBA:
  • Cells were grown in equal volume of DMEM and F12K with 5% bovine serum for 3-4 hours (20K cell/well) and compound was added at a concentration range of 0.07 μM to 50 μM. The cells were incubated at 37° C. overnight. Fifty μM of the culture supernatant was then taken for 5HTP measurement. The supernatant was mixed with equal volume of 1M TCA, then filtered through glass fiber. The filtrate was loaded on reverse phase HPLC for 5HTP concentration measurement. The cell viability was measured by treating the remaining cells with Promega Celltiter-Glo Luminescent Cell Viability Assay. The compound potency was then calculated in the same way as in the RBL CBA.
  • 6.57. In Vivo Effects
  • The in vivo effects of a potent TPH1 inhibitor of the invention were evaluated in several studies by determining the change of 5-HT levels in the intestines and brains of mice following oral administration of the compound.
  • The compound was formulated in different vehicles to provide either a suspension or solution. Generally, 14-week-old male C57 albino mice were dosed once daily by oral gavage at 5 ml/kg for four consecutive days. Five hours after the last dose, the animals were quickly sacrificed. Various regions of the intestinal tract and whole brain were taken and frozen immediately. 5-HT was extracted from the tissues and measured by HPLC. Blood samples were taken for exposure analysis.
  • The potent TPH1 inhibitor was found to reduce 5-HT levels in both the small and large intestine, but not in the brain. In one study, the compound was formulated in H2O and administered to mice at four different dose levels: 15, 50, 150, and 500 mg/kg, once daily by oral gavage. As shown in FIG. 1, the compound caused significant reduction of 5-HT in the jejunum and ileum in a dose-dependent fashion. In the colon, statistically significant reduction of 5-HT was seen at the 50, 150, and 500 mg/kg/day dose levels. No significant change of 5-HT levels was observed in the brain at any of the dose levels.
  • All publications (e.g., patents and patent applications) cited above are incorporated herein by reference in their entireties.

Claims (13)

What is claimed is:
1. A method of treating pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically effective amounts of a prostacyclin and a compound of the formula:
Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00088
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
A is optionally substituted cycloalkyl, aryl, or heterocycle;
X is a bond, —O—, —S—, —C(O)—, —C(R4)═, ═C(R4)—, —C(R3R4)—, —C(R4)═C(R4)—, —C≡C—, —N(R5)—, —N(R5)C(O)N(R5)—, —C(R3R4)N(R5)—, —N(R5)C(R3R4)—, —ONC(R3)—, —C(R3)NO—, —C(R3R4)O—, —OC(R3R4)—, —S(O2)—, —S(O2)N(R5)—, —N(R5)S(O2)—, —C(R3R4)S(O2)—, or —S(O2)C(R3R4)—;
D is optionally substituted aryl or heterocycle;
E is optionally substituted aryl or heterocycle;
R1 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle;
R2 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl, alkyl-heterocycle, aryl, or heterocycle;
R3 is hydrogen, alkoxy, amino, cyano, halogen, hydroxyl, or optionally substituted alkyl;
R4 is hydrogen, alkoxy, amino, cyano, halogen, hydroxyl, or optionally substituted alkyl or aryl;
R5 is hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl or aryl; and
n is 0-3.
2. The method of claim 1, wherein the compound is of the formula:
Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00089
wherein:
each of Z″1, Z″2, Z″3, and Z″4 is independently N or CR10;
each R10 is independently amino, cyano, halogen, hydrogen, OR11, SR11, NR12R13, or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle;
each R11 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle;
each R12 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle; and
each R13 is independently hydrogen or optionally substituted alkyl, alkyl-aryl or alkyl-heterocycle.
3. The method of claim 2, wherein the compound is of the formula:
Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00090
4. The method of claim 3, wherein A is optionally substituted biphenyl.
5. The method of claim 3, wherein R3 is trifluoromethyl.
6. The method of claim 3, wherein E is optionally substituted phenyl.
7. The method of claim 3, wherein R10 is amino.
8. The method of claim 1, wherein the prostacyclin is epoprostenol, iloprost or treprostinil.
9. A method of treating pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically effective amounts of a prostacyclin and a compound of the formula:
Figure US20130274261A1-20131017-C00091
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein A is optionally substituted cycloalkyl, aryl, or heterocycle; and R2 is hydrogen or lower alkyl.
10. The method of claim 9, wherein A is optionally substituted biphenyl.
11. The method of claim 9, wherein the prostacyclin is epoprostenol, iloprost or treprostinil.
12. A method of treating pulmonary hypertension, which comprises administering to a patient in need thereof therapeutically effective amounts of a prostacyclin and (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3′-methoxybiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
13. The method of claim 12, wherein the prostacyclin is epoprostenol, iloprost or treprostinil.
US13/845,533 2007-07-11 2013-03-18 Methods for treating pulmonary hypertension Abandoned US20130274261A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US13/845,533 US20130274261A1 (en) 2007-07-11 2013-03-18 Methods for treating pulmonary hypertension

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US94904007P 2007-07-11 2007-07-11
US12/169,815 US7875622B2 (en) 2007-07-11 2008-07-09 Methods and compositions for treating pulmonary hypertension and related diseases and disorders
US13/006,592 US8410121B2 (en) 2007-07-11 2011-01-14 Methods of treating pulmonary hypertension
US13/845,533 US20130274261A1 (en) 2007-07-11 2013-03-18 Methods for treating pulmonary hypertension

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US13/006,592 Continuation US8410121B2 (en) 2007-07-11 2011-01-14 Methods of treating pulmonary hypertension

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20130274261A1 true US20130274261A1 (en) 2013-10-17

Family

ID=39730871

Family Applications (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/169,815 Active 2029-02-13 US7875622B2 (en) 2007-07-11 2008-07-09 Methods and compositions for treating pulmonary hypertension and related diseases and disorders
US13/006,592 Active 2028-09-25 US8410121B2 (en) 2007-07-11 2011-01-14 Methods of treating pulmonary hypertension
US13/845,533 Abandoned US20130274261A1 (en) 2007-07-11 2013-03-18 Methods for treating pulmonary hypertension

Family Applications Before (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/169,815 Active 2029-02-13 US7875622B2 (en) 2007-07-11 2008-07-09 Methods and compositions for treating pulmonary hypertension and related diseases and disorders
US13/006,592 Active 2028-09-25 US8410121B2 (en) 2007-07-11 2011-01-14 Methods of treating pulmonary hypertension

Country Status (10)

Country Link
US (3) US7875622B2 (en)
EP (1) EP2170397A1 (en)
JP (1) JP2010533196A (en)
KR (1) KR20100046189A (en)
CN (1) CN101815534A (en)
AU (1) AU2008275179B2 (en)
BR (1) BRPI0814105A2 (en)
CA (1) CA2693400A1 (en)
EA (1) EA201070127A1 (en)
WO (1) WO2009009561A1 (en)

Cited By (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2014110491A1 (en) 2013-01-11 2014-07-17 Theratrophix Llc Prodrugs of treprostinil
WO2016010538A1 (en) 2014-07-16 2016-01-21 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US9505737B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2016-11-29 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US9701616B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2017-07-11 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
WO2018060949A1 (en) 2016-09-30 2018-04-05 Roivant Sciences Gmbh Tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitors for use in the treatment of liver diseases
US9957220B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2018-05-01 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof

Families Citing this family (17)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
ES2684821T3 (en) * 2005-12-29 2018-10-04 Lexicon Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Multicyclic amino acid derivatives and methods of their use
BRPI0813212A2 (en) * 2007-06-26 2014-12-23 Lexicon Pharmaceuticals Inc SEROTONIN-MEDIATED DISEASE AND DISEASE TREATMENT METHODS
EP2170335A1 (en) * 2007-06-26 2010-04-07 Lexicon Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions comprising tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitors
BRPI0814105A2 (en) * 2007-07-11 2015-02-03 Lexicon Pharmaceuticals Inc METHODS AND COMPOSITIONS FOR TREATMENT OF PULMONARY HYPERTENSION AND RELATED DISEASES AND DISORDERS
TW200932729A (en) * 2007-10-08 2009-08-01 Lexicon Pharmaceuticals Inc Solid forms of (S)-2-amino-3-(4-(2-amino-6-((R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-(3'-methoxybiphenyl-4-yl)ethoxy)pyrimidin-4-yl)phenyl)propanoic acid and methods of their use
CN102083454A (en) * 2008-03-31 2011-06-01 纽约市哥伦比亚大学托管会 Methods of diagnosing, preventing and treating bone mass diseases
US8815883B2 (en) 2009-11-02 2014-08-26 The Trustees Of Columbia Unviersity In The City Of New York Compounds and methods for inhibiting serotonin synthesis
TWI513694B (en) 2010-05-11 2015-12-21 Amgen Inc Pyrimidine compounds that inhibit anaplastic lymphoma kinase
EP2582666B1 (en) 2010-06-16 2014-08-13 Purdue Pharma L.P. Aryl substituted indoles and their use as blockers of sodium channels
US20130303763A1 (en) 2012-03-30 2013-11-14 Michael D. Gershon Methods and compositions for the treatment of necrotizing enterocolitis
UA119247C2 (en) 2013-09-06 2019-05-27 РОЙВЕНТ САЙЕНСИЗ ҐмбГ Spirocyclic compounds as tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitors
RU2668166C1 (en) * 2013-12-17 2018-09-27 Стелла Фарма Корпорейшн Method of producing 2-fluoro-4-borono-l-phenylalanine and precursor of 2-fluoro-4-borono-l-phenylalanine
US9611201B2 (en) 2015-03-05 2017-04-04 Karos Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Processes for preparing (R)-1-(5-chloro-[1,1′-biphenyl]-2-yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanol and 1-(5-chloro-[1,1′-biphenyl]-2-yl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethanone
EP3674303B1 (en) * 2017-08-24 2022-07-20 Gwangju Institute of Science and Technology Novel tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitor and pharmaceutical composition including same
AU2019382168A1 (en) 2018-11-16 2021-06-03 Altavant Sciences Gmbh A method for treating pulmonary arterial hypertension and associated pulmonary arterial hypertension
WO2020157577A1 (en) 2019-01-30 2020-08-06 Altavant Sciences Gmbh A dosage regime and method for treating pulmonary arterial hypertension with rodatristat ethyl
MX2021011224A (en) * 2019-03-15 2021-12-10 Altavant Sciences Gmbh A method for treating pulmonary arterial hypertension and associated pulmonary arterial hypertension and daily dosing.

Family Cites Families (18)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4156734A (en) 1976-02-13 1979-05-29 Merck & Co., Inc. Antihypertensive compositions containing an aryl-substituted alanine azo and an arylhydrazino-propionic acid
JPH04506967A (en) 1989-07-27 1992-12-03 ジー.ディー.サール アンド カンパニー Renal selective products for the treatment of hypertension
ES2206953T3 (en) 1997-06-23 2004-05-16 Tanabe Seiyaku Co., Ltd. INHIBITORS OF THE CELLULAR ADHERENCE MEDIATED BY ALFA 4-BETA
MY153569A (en) 1998-01-20 2015-02-27 Mitsubishi Tanabe Pharma Corp Inhibitors of ?4 mediated cell adhesion
EP1214292B1 (en) 1999-09-24 2007-06-13 Genentech, Inc. Tyrosine derivatives
TWI224966B (en) * 1999-11-02 2004-12-11 Pfizer Pharmaceutical composition (I) useful for treating or preventing pulmonary hypertension in a patient
WO2004017993A1 (en) 2002-08-12 2004-03-04 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Combination of prostacyclin or prostacyclin analogues and endothelin receptor antagonists for the treatment of pulmonary arterial hypertension
JP4942297B2 (en) * 2002-10-25 2012-05-30 ジ アドミニストレイターズ オブ ザ チューレン エデュケイショナル ファンド N- {5- [4- (4-Methylpiperazinomethyl) -benzoylamide] -2-methylphenyl} -4- (3-pyridyl) -2-pyridin-amine for the treatment of pulmonary hypertension Use of
AU2003301226A1 (en) 2002-12-20 2004-07-22 Pharmacia Corp Acyclic pyrazole compounds for the inhibition of mitogen activated protein kinase-activated protein kinase-2
US6794401B2 (en) 2003-01-17 2004-09-21 Bexel Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Amino acid phenoxy ethers
WO2005044780A1 (en) 2003-11-10 2005-05-19 Kyorin Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Aminocarboxylic acid derivative, addition salt thereof, and s1p receptor control agent
AU2005244751A1 (en) 2004-04-16 2005-12-01 Genentech, Inc. Method for augmenting B cell depletion
ES2684821T3 (en) 2005-12-29 2018-10-04 Lexicon Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Multicyclic amino acid derivatives and methods of their use
US7855291B2 (en) 2005-12-29 2010-12-21 Lexicon Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Process for the preparation of substituted phenylalanines
UA99270C2 (en) 2006-12-12 2012-08-10 Лексикон Фармасьютикалз, Инк. 4-phenyl-6-(2,2,2-trifluoro-1-phenylethoxy)pyrimidine-based compounds and methods of their use
HUE025355T2 (en) * 2006-12-12 2016-02-29 Gilead Sciences Inc Composition for treating a pulmonary hypertension
BRPI0813212A2 (en) 2007-06-26 2014-12-23 Lexicon Pharmaceuticals Inc SEROTONIN-MEDIATED DISEASE AND DISEASE TREATMENT METHODS
BRPI0814105A2 (en) 2007-07-11 2015-02-03 Lexicon Pharmaceuticals Inc METHODS AND COMPOSITIONS FOR TREATMENT OF PULMONARY HYPERTENSION AND RELATED DISEASES AND DISORDERS

Cited By (30)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11505535B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2022-11-22 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US9845305B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2017-12-19 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US9371264B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2016-06-21 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US9505737B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2016-11-29 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US10752605B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2020-08-25 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US9776982B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2017-10-03 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
EP3712142A1 (en) 2013-01-11 2020-09-23 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Prodrugs of treprostinil
EP4137127A1 (en) 2013-01-11 2023-02-22 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Prodrugs of treprostinil
US11958822B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2024-04-16 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US11339139B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2022-05-24 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US11046666B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2021-06-29 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US10344012B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2019-07-09 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US10450290B2 (en) 2013-01-11 2019-10-22 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
WO2014110491A1 (en) 2013-01-11 2014-07-17 Theratrophix Llc Prodrugs of treprostinil
EP3828160A1 (en) 2014-07-16 2021-06-02 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
WO2016010538A1 (en) 2014-07-16 2016-01-21 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivative compounds and methods of using same
US11034645B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2021-06-15 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US10053414B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2018-08-21 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US10703706B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2020-07-07 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US10988435B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2021-04-27 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US10464877B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2019-11-05 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US10464878B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2019-11-05 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US10246403B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2019-04-02 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US10759733B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2020-09-01 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US11407707B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2022-08-09 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US9957220B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2018-05-01 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US9701616B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2017-07-11 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US11802105B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2023-10-31 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
US11866402B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2024-01-09 Corsair Pharma, Inc. Treprostinil derivatives and compositions and uses thereof
WO2018060949A1 (en) 2016-09-30 2018-04-05 Roivant Sciences Gmbh Tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitors for use in the treatment of liver diseases

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
AU2008275179B2 (en) 2013-09-12
KR20100046189A (en) 2010-05-06
CA2693400A1 (en) 2009-01-15
EA201070127A1 (en) 2010-08-30
US20110112094A1 (en) 2011-05-12
AU2008275179A1 (en) 2009-01-15
US7875622B2 (en) 2011-01-25
US8410121B2 (en) 2013-04-02
BRPI0814105A2 (en) 2015-02-03
EP2170397A1 (en) 2010-04-07
WO2009009561A1 (en) 2009-01-15
JP2010533196A (en) 2010-10-21
US20090054308A1 (en) 2009-02-26
CN101815534A (en) 2010-08-25

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US8410121B2 (en) Methods of treating pulmonary hypertension
US8629156B2 (en) Tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitors
US20110263601A1 (en) Methods of treating ulcerative colitis
US8093291B2 (en) Methods of using and compositions comprising tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitors
US20090029993A1 (en) Methods of affecting gastrointestinal transit and gastric emptying, and compounds useful therein
US20130137635A1 (en) Tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitors for the treatment of metastatic bone disease
US20120316171A1 (en) Tryptophan Hydroxylase Inhibitors for the Treatment of Cancer
WO2010062829A1 (en) Tryptophan hydroxylase inhibitors for treating osteoporosis

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION

AS Assignment

Owner name: BIOPHARMA CREDIT PLC, UNITED KINGDOM

Free format text: SECURITY INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:LEXICON PHARMACEUTICALS, INC.;REEL/FRAME:044958/0377

Effective date: 20171204

AS Assignment

Owner name: LEXICON PHARMACEUTICALS, INC., TEXAS

Free format text: RELEASE BY SECURED PARTY;ASSIGNOR:BIOPHARMA CREDIT PLC;REEL/FRAME:053767/0445

Effective date: 20200908